blob: 370fd53e531c037c1aa135abaccb0fd42a39c0c4 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau2e858402014-05-28 17:50:53 +02007 2014/05/28
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
451 - gid
452 - group
453 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100454 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 - nbproc
456 - pidfile
457 - uid
458 - ulimit-n
459 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200460 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100461 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200462 - node
463 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100464 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100465
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200466 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200467 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200468 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200469 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100470 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100471 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100472 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200473 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200474 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200475 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200476 - noepoll
477 - nokqueue
478 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100479 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300480 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200481 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200482 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200483 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100484 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100485 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200486 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100487 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100488 - tune.maxaccept
489 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200490 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200491 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100492 - tune.rcvbuf.client
493 - tune.rcvbuf.server
494 - tune.sndbuf.client
495 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100496 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100497 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200498 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100499 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200500 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100501 - tune.zlib.memlevel
502 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100503
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200504 * Debugging
505 - debug
506 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200507
508
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005093.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200510------------------------------------
511
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200512ca-base <dir>
513 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200514 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
515 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200516
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517chroot <jail dir>
518 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
519 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
520 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
521 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
522 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
523 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100524
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100525cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
526 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
527 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
528 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100529 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
530 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
531 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
532 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
533 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
534 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
535 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
536 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
537 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
538 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100539
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200540crt-base <dir>
541 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
542 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
543 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
544
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200545daemon
546 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
547 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
548 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
549
550gid <number>
551 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
552 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
553 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100554 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
555 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100557
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200558group <group name>
559 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
560 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100561
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200562log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200563 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
564 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100565 configured with "log global".
566
567 <address> can be one of:
568
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100569 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100570 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
571 port).
572
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100573 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
574 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
575 port).
576
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100577 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
578 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
579 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
580 writeable).
581
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100582 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
583 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
584 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
585 in Bourne shell.
586
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100587 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200588
589 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
590 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
591 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
592
593 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200594 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
595 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
596 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
597 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
598 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
599 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200600
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200601 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200602
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100603log-send-hostname [<string>]
604 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
605 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
606 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
607 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
608 the logs.
609
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000610log-tag <string>
611 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
612 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
613 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
614 running on the same host.
615
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200616nbproc <number>
617 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
618 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
619 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
620 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
621 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
622
623pidfile <pidfile>
624 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
625 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
626 starting the process. See also "daemon".
627
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100628stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200629 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
630 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
631 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
632 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
633 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
634 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100635 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200636 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
637 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200638
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100639ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
640 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
641 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300642 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100643 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
644 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
645 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
646 "bind" keyword for more information.
647
648ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
649 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
650 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300651 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100652 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
653 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
654 information.
655
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100656ssl-server-verify [none|required]
657 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
658 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
659 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
660
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200661stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
662 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
663 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
664 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
665 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200666
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200667 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
668 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
669 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200670
671stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
672 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
673 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100674 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200675
676stats maxconn <connections>
677 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
678 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
679
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200680uid <number>
681 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
682 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
683 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
684 one. See also "gid" and "user".
685
686ulimit-n <number>
687 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
688 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
689 option.
690
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100691unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
692 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
693
694 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
695 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
696 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
697 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
698 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
699 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
700 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
701 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
702 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
703 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
704
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200705user <user name>
706 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
707 See also "uid" and "group".
708
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200709node <name>
710 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
711
712 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
713 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
714 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
715 traffic.
716
717description <text>
718 Add a text that describes the instance.
719
720 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
721 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
722 "<" and ">" characters.
723
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200724
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007253.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200726-----------------------
727
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200728max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
729 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
730 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
731 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
732 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
733 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
734 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
735 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
736 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
737
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200738maxconn <number>
739 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
740 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
741 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
742 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
743
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200744maxconnrate <number>
745 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
746 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
747 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
748 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
749 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
750 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
751 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
752 fairness.
753
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100754maxcomprate <number>
755 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300756 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100757 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
758 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
759 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
760 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
761 default value.
762
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100763maxcompcpuusage <number>
764 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
765 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
766 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
767 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
768 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
769 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
770 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
771 process down and from introducing high latencies.
772
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100773maxpipes <number>
774 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
775 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
776 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
777 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
778 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
779 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
780
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200781maxsessrate <number>
782 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
783 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
784 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
785 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
786 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
787 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
788 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
789 fairness.
790
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200791maxsslconn <number>
792 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
793 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
794 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
795 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
796 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
797 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
798 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
799
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200800maxsslrate <number>
801 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
802 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
803 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
804 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
805 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
806 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
807 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
808 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
809 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
810 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
811
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100812maxzlibmem <number>
813 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
814 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
815 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100816 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
817 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
818 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
819
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820noepoll
821 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
822 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100823 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200824
825nokqueue
826 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
827 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
828 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
829
830nopoll
831 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
832 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100833 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100834 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200835
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100836nosplice
837 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
838 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
839 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100840 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100841 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
842 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
843 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
844 "option splice-response".
845
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300846nogetaddrinfo
847 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
848 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
849
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200850spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900851 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
852 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
853 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
854 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
855 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
856 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200857
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200858tune.bufsize <number>
859 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
860 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
861 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
862 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
863 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
864 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
865 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
866 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400867 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
868 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
869 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200870
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200871tune.chksize <number>
872 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
873 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
874 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
875 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
876 checks whenever possible.
877
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100878tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
879 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
880 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
881 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
882 this value. The default value is 1.
883
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100884tune.http.cookielen <number>
885 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
886 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
887 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
888 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
889 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
890 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
891 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
892 to change this value.
893
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200894tune.http.maxhdr <number>
895 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
896 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
897 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
898 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
899 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
900 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
901 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
902 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
903 limit too high.
904
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100905tune.idletimer <timeout>
906 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
907 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
908 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
909 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
910 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
911 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
912 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
913 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
914 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
915
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100916tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100917 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
918 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
919 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
920 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
921 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
922 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
923 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
924 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
925 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
926 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100927
928tune.maxpollevents <number>
929 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
930 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
931 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
932 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
933 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
934
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200935tune.maxrewrite <number>
936 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
937 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
938 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
939 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
940 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
941 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
942 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
943 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
944 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
945 bufsize.
946
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200947tune.pipesize <number>
948 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
949 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
950 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
951 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
952 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
953 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
954
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100955tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
956tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
957 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
958 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
959 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
960 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
961 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
962 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
963 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
964
965tune.sndbuf.client <number>
966tune.sndbuf.server <number>
967 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
968 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
969 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
970 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
971 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
972 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
973 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
974 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
975 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
976 notifying haproxy again.
977
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100978tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100979 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
980 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
981 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300982 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100983 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
984 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
985 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
986 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
987 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +0100988 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
989 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100990
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200991tune.ssl.force-private-cache
992 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
993 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
994 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
995 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
996 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
997 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
998
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100999tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1000 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001001 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001002 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1003 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1004 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1005 being used for too long.
1006
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001007tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1008 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1009 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1010 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1011 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1012 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1013 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1014 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1015 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1016 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1017 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001018 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1019 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001020
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001021tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1022 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1023 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1024 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1025 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1026 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1027 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1028 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
1029 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied via the certificate file.
1030
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001031tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1032 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001033 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001034 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1035 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1036 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1037
1038tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1039 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1040 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1041 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1042 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001043
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010443.3. Debugging
1045--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001046
1047debug
1048 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1049 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1050 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1051 system startup.
1052
1053quiet
1054 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1055 line argument "-q".
1056
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001057
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010583.4. Userlists
1059--------------
1060It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1061http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1062it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1063
1064userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001065 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001066 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1067
1068group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001069 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001070 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1071 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1072
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001073user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1074 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001075 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1076 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001077 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1078 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001079 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001080 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001081
1082
1083 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001084 userlist L1
1085 group G1 users tiger,scott
1086 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001087
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001088 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1089 user scott insecure-password elgato
1090 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001091
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001092 userlist L2
1093 group G1
1094 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001095
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001096 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1097 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1098 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001099
1100 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001101
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001102
11033.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001104----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001105It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1106haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1107pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1108identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1109or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1110Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1111known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1112the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1113process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1114during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1115tables.
1116
1117peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001118 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001119 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1120
1121peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1122 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1123 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1124 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1125 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1126 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1127 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1128
1129 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1130 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1131
1132 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1133 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1134 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1135 across all peers.
1136
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001137 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1138 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1139 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1140
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001141 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001142 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001143 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1144 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1145 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001146
1147 backend mybackend
1148 mode tcp
1149 balance roundrobin
1150 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1151 stick on src
1152
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001153 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1154 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001155
1156
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011574. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001158----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001159
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001160Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1161 - defaults <name>
1162 - frontend <name>
1163 - backend <name>
1164 - listen <name>
1165
1166A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1167its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1168section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001169section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001170
1171A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1172connections.
1173
1174A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1175to forward incoming connections.
1176
1177A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1178parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1179
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001180All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1181'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1182case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1183
1184Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1185logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1186proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1187However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1188name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1189
1190Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1191and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001192bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001193protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1194modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1195arbitrary criteria.
1196
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001197In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1198a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1199the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1200
1201 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1202 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1203 between responses and new requests.
1204
1205 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1206 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1207 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1208 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1209
1210 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1211 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1212 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1213
1214 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1215 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1216 client-facing connection remains open.
1217
1218 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1219 after the end of the response.
1220
1221The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1222frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1223following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1224weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1225
1226 Backend mode
1227
1228 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1229 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1230 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1231 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1232 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1233 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1234 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1235 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1236 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1237 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1238 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1239
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001240
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001241
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012424.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1243--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001244
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001245The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1246limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1247they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1248limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001249marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001250option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001251and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1252with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1253specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001254
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001255
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001256 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1257------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1258acl - X X X
1259appsession - - X X
1260backlog X X X -
1261balance X - X X
1262bind - X X -
1263bind-process X X X X
1264block - X X X
1265capture cookie - X X -
1266capture request header - X X -
1267capture response header - X X -
1268clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001269compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001270contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1271cookie X - X X
1272default-server X - X X
1273default_backend X X X -
1274description - X X X
1275disabled X X X X
1276dispatch - - X X
1277enabled X X X X
1278errorfile X X X X
1279errorloc X X X X
1280errorloc302 X X X X
1281-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1282errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001283force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001284fullconn X - X X
1285grace X X X X
1286hash-type X - X X
1287http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001288http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001289http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001290http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001291http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001292http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001293id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001294ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001295log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001296max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001297maxconn X X X -
1298mode X X X X
1299monitor fail - X X -
1300monitor-net X X X -
1301monitor-uri X X X -
1302option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1303option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1304option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1305option allbackups (*) X - X X
1306option checkcache (*) X - X X
1307option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1308option contstats (*) X X X -
1309option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1310option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1311option forceclose (*) X X X X
1312-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1313option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001314option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001315option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001316option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001317option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001318option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001319option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1320option httpchk X - X X
1321option httpclose (*) X X X X
1322option httplog X X X X
1323option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001324option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001325option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001326option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1327option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1328option logasap (*) X X X -
1329option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001330option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001331option nolinger (*) X X X X
1332option originalto X X X X
1333option persist (*) X - X X
1334option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001335option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001336option smtpchk X - X X
1337option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1338option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1339option splice-request (*) X X X X
1340option splice-response (*) X X X X
1341option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1342option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1343-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001344option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001345option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1346option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1347option tcpka X X X X
1348option tcplog X X X X
1349option transparent (*) X - X X
1350persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1351rate-limit sessions X X X -
1352redirect - X X X
1353redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1354redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1355reqadd - X X X
1356reqallow - X X X
1357reqdel - X X X
1358reqdeny - X X X
1359reqiallow - X X X
1360reqidel - X X X
1361reqideny - X X X
1362reqipass - X X X
1363reqirep - X X X
1364reqisetbe - X X X
1365reqitarpit - X X X
1366reqpass - X X X
1367reqrep - X X X
1368-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1369reqsetbe - X X X
1370reqtarpit - X X X
1371retries X - X X
1372rspadd - X X X
1373rspdel - X X X
1374rspdeny - X X X
1375rspidel - X X X
1376rspideny - X X X
1377rspirep - X X X
1378rsprep - X X X
1379server - - X X
1380source X - X X
1381srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001382stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001383stats auth X - X X
1384stats enable X - X X
1385stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001386stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001387stats realm X - X X
1388stats refresh X - X X
1389stats scope X - X X
1390stats show-desc X - X X
1391stats show-legends X - X X
1392stats show-node X - X X
1393stats uri X - X X
1394-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1395stick match - - X X
1396stick on - - X X
1397stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001398stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001399stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001400tcp-check connect - - X X
1401tcp-check expect - - X X
1402tcp-check send - - X X
1403tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001404tcp-request connection - X X -
1405tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001406tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001407tcp-response content - - X X
1408tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001409timeout check X - X X
1410timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001411timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001412timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1413timeout connect X - X X
1414timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1415timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1416timeout http-request X X X X
1417timeout queue X - X X
1418timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001419timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001420timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1421timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001422timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001423transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001424unique-id-format X X X -
1425unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001426use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001427use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001428------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1429 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001430
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001431
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014324.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1433---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001434
1435This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1436
1437
1438acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1439 Declare or complete an access list.
1440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1441 no | yes | yes | yes
1442 Example:
1443 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1444 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1445 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1446
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001447 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001448
1449
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001450appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1451 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001452 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1454 no | no | yes | yes
1455 Arguments :
1456 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1457 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1458
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001459 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001460 checked in each cookie value.
1461
1462 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1463 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1464 milliseconds.
1465
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001466 request-learn
1467 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1468 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1469 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1470 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1471 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1472 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1473
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001474 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1475 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1476 data following this prefix.
1477
1478 Example :
1479 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1480
1481 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1482 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1483
1484 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1485 2 modes are currently supported :
1486 - path-parameters :
1487 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1488 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1489 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1490 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1491 - query-string :
1492 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1493 query string.
1494
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001495 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1496 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1497 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1498 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001499 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1500 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1501 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001502 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1503 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1504
1505 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1506
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001507 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1508 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1509 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1510
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001511 Example :
1512 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1513
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001514 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1515 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001516
1517
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001518backlog <conns>
1519 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1521 yes | yes | yes | no
1522 Arguments :
1523 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1524 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001525 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001526
1527 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1528 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1529 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1530 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1531 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1532 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1533 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1534 backlog parameter.
1535
1536 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1537 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1538 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1539
1540 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1541
1542
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001543balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001544balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001545 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1547 yes | no | yes | yes
1548 Arguments :
1549 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1550 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1551 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1552 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1553
1554 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1555 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1556 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1557 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001558 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001559 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001560 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1561 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1562 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1563 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1564 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1565 it, so that you don't worry.
1566
1567 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1568 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1569 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1570 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1571 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1572 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1573 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1574 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001575
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001576 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1577 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1578 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1579 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1580 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1581 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1582 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1583 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1584
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001585 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001586 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001587 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1588 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001589 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001590 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1591 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1592 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1593 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1594 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001595 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1596 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1597 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1598 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1599 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1600 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001601
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001602 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1603 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1604 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1605 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1606 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1607 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1608 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1609 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001610 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001611 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001612 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1613 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1614 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001615
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001616 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1617 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1618 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1619 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1620 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1621 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1622 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1623 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1624 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1625 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1626 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1627 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001628
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001629 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001630 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1631 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1632 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1633 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1634 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1635 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1636 URIs start with a leading "/".
1637
1638 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1639 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1640 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1641 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1642
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001643 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001644 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1645
1646 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001647 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1648 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001649 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1650 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1651 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1652 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001653 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001654 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1655 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001656
1657 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1658 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1659 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1660 server will receive the request.
1661
1662 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1663 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1664 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1665 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1666 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001667 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1668 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1669 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001670
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001671 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1672 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1673 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1674 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1675 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001676
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001677 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001678 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1679 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1680 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1681
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001682 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1683 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1684 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1685
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001686 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001687 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001688 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1689 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1690 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1691 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1692 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1693 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001694 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001695 used instead.
1696
1697 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1698 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1699 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1700 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1701
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001702 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1703 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1704 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1705
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001706 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001707
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001708 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001709 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1710 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001711
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001712 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1713 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1714 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001715
1716 Examples :
1717 balance roundrobin
1718 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001719 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001720 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1721 balance hdr(host)
1722 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001723
1724 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1725 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1726
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001727 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001728 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1729 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1730 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1731 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1732
1733 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1734 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1735 defaults to 16 kB.
1736
1737 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1738 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1739
1740 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1741 Round Robin.
1742
1743 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1744 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1745 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1746 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1747
1748 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1749
1750 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001751 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001752 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1753 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1754 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001755
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001756 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1757 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001758
1759
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001760bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1761bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001762 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1764 no | yes | yes | no
1765 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001766 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1767 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1768 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1769 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001770 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001771 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1772 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1773 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1774 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1775 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1776 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1777 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02001778 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001779 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1780 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1781 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001782 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1783 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1784 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1785 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001786
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001787 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1788 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001789 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1790 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1791 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001792 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1793 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1794 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1795 the range.
1796
1797 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1798 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1799 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1800 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1801 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1802 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1803 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001804 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001805 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001806
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001807 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1808 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1809 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1810 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1811 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1812 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1813 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1814 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1815
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001816 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1817 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1818 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1819 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001820
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001821 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1822 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1823 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1824 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1825 in a frontend.
1826
1827 Example :
1828 listen http_proxy
1829 bind :80,:443
1830 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001831 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001832
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001833 listen http_https_proxy
1834 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001835 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001836
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001837 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1838 bind ipv6@:80
1839 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1840 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1841
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001842 listen external_bind_app1
1843 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1844
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001845 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001846 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001847
1848
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001849bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001850 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1852 yes | yes | yes | yes
1853 Arguments :
1854 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1855 may be used to override a default value.
1856
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001857 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001858 option may be combined with other numbers.
1859
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001860 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001861 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1862 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1863 missing from all processes.
1864
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001865 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001866 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02001867 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
1868 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
1869 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
1870 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001871
1872 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1873 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1874 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1875 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1876 and 'even' instances.
1877
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001878 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
1879 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
1880 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
1881 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001882
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001883 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
1884 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
1885
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001886 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1887 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1888
1889 Example :
1890 listen app_ip1
1891 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001892 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001893
1894 listen app_ip2
1895 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001896 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001897
1898 listen management
1899 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001900 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001901
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001902 listen management
1903 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1904 bind-process 1-4
1905
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001906 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001907
1908
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001909block { if | unless } <condition>
1910 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1912 no | yes | yes | yes
1913
1914 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1915 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001916 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001917 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001918 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1919 "block" statements per instance.
1920
1921 Example:
1922 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1923 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1924 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1925 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1926
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001927 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001928
1929
1930capture cookie <name> len <length>
1931 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1933 no | yes | yes | no
1934 Arguments :
1935 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1936 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1937 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1938 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1939 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1940
1941 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1942 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1943 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1944 right if it exceeds <length>.
1945
1946 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1947 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1948 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1949 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1950
1951 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1952 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1953 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1954
1955 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1956 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1957 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001958 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1959 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1960 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001961
1962 Example:
1963 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1964
1965 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001966 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001967
1968
1969capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001970 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1972 no | yes | yes | no
1973 Arguments :
1974 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001975 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001976 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1977 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1978 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1979
1980 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1981 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1982 it exceeds <length>.
1983
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001984 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001985 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1986 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001987 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1988 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1989 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1990 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001991 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001992 environments to find where the request came from.
1993
1994 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1995 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1996 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1997 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001998
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001999 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2000 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2001 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2002 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2003 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002004
2005 Example:
2006 capture request header Host len 15
2007 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2008 capture request header Referrer len 15
2009
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002010 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002011 about logging.
2012
2013
2014capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002015 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2017 no | yes | yes | no
2018 Arguments :
2019 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002020 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002021 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2022 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2023 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2024
2025 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2026 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2027 it exceeds <length>.
2028
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002029 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002030 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2031 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2032 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002033 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2034 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2035 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2036 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002037
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002038 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2039 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2040 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2041 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2042 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002043
2044 Example:
2045 capture response header Content-length len 9
2046 capture response header Location len 15
2047
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002048 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002049 about logging.
2050
2051
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002052clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002053 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2055 yes | yes | yes | no
2056 Arguments :
2057 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2058 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2059 as explained at the top of this document.
2060
2061 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2062 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2063 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2064 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2065 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2066 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2067 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2068 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002069 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002070 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2071 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2072
2073 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2074 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2075 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2076 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2077 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2078 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2079
2080 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2081 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2082
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002083 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2084 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002085
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002086compression algo <algorithm> ...
2087compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002088compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002089 Enable HTTP compression.
2090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2091 yes | yes | yes | yes
2092 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002093 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2094 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2095 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2096
2097 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002098 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002099 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2100 data.
2101
2102 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2103 support for zlib was built in.
2104
2105 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2106 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2107 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2108 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2109 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2110 in.
2111
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002112 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002113 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002114 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2115 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2116 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2117 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2118 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002119
2120 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2121 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2122 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2123 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2124 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002125 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2126 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2127 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2128 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2129 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
2130 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002131
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002132 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002133 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2134 "Accept-Encoding" header
2135 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002136 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002137 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2138 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002139 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2140 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2141 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2142 "multipart"
2143 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2144 header
2145 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2146 and later
2147 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2148 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002149
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002150 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2151 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002152
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002153 Examples :
2154 compression algo gzip
2155 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002156
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002157contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002158 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2160 yes | no | yes | yes
2161 Arguments :
2162 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2163 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2164 as explained at the top of this document.
2165
2166 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002167 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002168 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002169 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2170 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2171 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2172 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2173
2174 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2175 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2176 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2177 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2178 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2179 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2180
2181 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2182 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2183 instead.
2184
2185 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2186 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2187
2188
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002189cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002190 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2191 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002192 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2194 yes | no | yes | yes
2195 Arguments :
2196 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2197 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2198 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2199 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2200 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2201 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2202 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2203 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2204 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2205
2206 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2207 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2208 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2209 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2210 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2211 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2212 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2213 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2214 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2215 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2216 "insert" and "prefix".
2217
2218 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002219 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002220
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002221 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002222 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2223 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2224 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2225 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2226 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2227 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2228 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2229 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2230 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2231 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002232
2233 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2234 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2235 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2236 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2237 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2238 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2239 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2240 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2241 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2242 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002243 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2244 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2245 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002246
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002247 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2248 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2249 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002250 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2251 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2252 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2253 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002254 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2255 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2256 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002257
2258 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2259 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2260 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2261 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2262 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2263 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2264 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2265 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2266 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2267
2268 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2269 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2270 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2271 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2272 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2273 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2274 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2275 persistence cookie in the cache.
2276 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2277
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002278 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2279 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2280 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2281 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2282 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2283 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2284 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2285 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2286 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2287 they logout.
2288
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002289 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2290 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2291 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2292 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2293
2294 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2295 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2296 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2297 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2298 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2299 this attribute.
2300
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002301 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002302 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002303 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2304 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2305 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2306 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2307 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2308 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002309
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002310 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2311 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2312 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2313 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2314 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2315 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2316 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2317 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2318 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2319 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2320 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2321 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2322 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2323 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2324 the site.
2325
2326 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2327 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2328 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2329 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2330 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2331 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2332 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2333 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2334 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2335 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2336 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2337 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2338 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2339 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2340 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2341 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2342
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002343 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2344 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2345 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2346 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002347
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002348 Examples :
2349 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2350 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2351 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002352 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002353
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002354 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002355 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002356
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002357
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002358default-server [param*]
2359 Change default options for a server in a backend
2360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2361 yes | no | yes | yes
2362 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002363 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2364 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2365 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2366 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002367
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002368 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002369 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2370
2371 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002372
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002373
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002374default_backend <backend>
2375 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2377 yes | yes | yes | no
2378 Arguments :
2379 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2380
2381 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2382 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2383 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2384 will catch all undetermined requests.
2385
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002386 Example :
2387
2388 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2389 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2390 default_backend dynamic
2391
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002392 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2393
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002394
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002395description <string>
2396 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2398 no | yes | yes | yes
2399 Arguments : string
2400
2401 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2402 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2403 it describes.
2404 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2405
2406
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002407disabled
2408 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2410 yes | yes | yes | yes
2411 Arguments : none
2412
2413 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2414 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2415 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2416 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2417 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2418 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2419 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2420
2421 See also : "enabled"
2422
2423
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002424dispatch <address>:<port>
2425 Set a default server address
2426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2427 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002428 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002429
2430 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2431 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2432 during start-up.
2433
2434 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2435 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2436 possible with normal servers.
2437
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002438 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002439 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2440 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2441 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2442 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2443
2444 See also : "server"
2445
2446
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002447enabled
2448 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2450 yes | yes | yes | yes
2451 Arguments : none
2452
2453 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2454 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2455
2456 See also : "disabled"
2457
2458
2459errorfile <code> <file>
2460 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2462 yes | yes | yes | yes
2463 Arguments :
2464 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002465 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002466
2467 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002468 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002469 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002470 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2471 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002472
2473 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2474 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2475 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2476
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002477 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2478
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002479 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2480 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2481 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2482 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2483
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002484 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2485 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2486 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2487 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2488 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2489 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2490
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002491 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2492 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2493 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002494 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002495 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2496
2497 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2498
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002499 Example :
2500 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002501 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002502 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2503 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2504
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002505
2506errorloc <code> <url>
2507errorloc302 <code> <url>
2508 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2510 yes | yes | yes | yes
2511 Arguments :
2512 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002513 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002514
2515 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2516 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2517 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2518 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2519 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2520
2521 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2522 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2523 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2524
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002525 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2526
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002527 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2528 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2529 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2530 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2531 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2532 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2533 request.
2534
2535 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2536
2537
2538errorloc303 <code> <url>
2539 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2541 yes | yes | yes | yes
2542 Arguments :
2543 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2544 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2545
2546 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2547 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2548 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2549 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2550 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2551
2552 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2553 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2554 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2555
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002556 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2557
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002558 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2559 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2560 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2561 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002562 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002563
2564 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2565
2566
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002567force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2568 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2569 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2570 no | yes | yes | yes
2571
2572 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2573 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2574 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2575 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2576 marked down for maintenance operations.
2577
2578 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2579 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2580 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2581 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2582 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2583 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2584 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2585 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2586 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2587
2588 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2589 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2590 is used.
2591
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002592 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002593 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002594
2595
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002596fullconn <conns>
2597 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2599 yes | no | yes | yes
2600 Arguments :
2601 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2602 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2603
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002604 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002605 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002606 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002607 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2608 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2609 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2610 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2611 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002612 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002613
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002614 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2615 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002616 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2617 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2618 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002619
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002620 Example :
2621 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2622 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2623 # connections.
2624 backend dynamic
2625 fullconn 10000
2626 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2627 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2628
2629 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2630
2631
2632grace <time>
2633 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002635 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002636 Arguments :
2637 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2638 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2639 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2640
2641 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2642 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002643 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002644 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2645
2646 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2647 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2648 simplify it.
2649
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002650
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002651hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002652 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2654 yes | no | yes | yes
2655 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002656 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2657 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002658
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002659 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2660 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2661 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2662 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2663 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2664 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2665 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2666 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2667 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2668 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002669
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002670 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2671 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2672 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2673 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2674 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2675 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2676 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2677 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2678 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2679 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2680 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2681 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2682 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002683 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2684 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002685
2686 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2687
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002688 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002689 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2690 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2691 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002692 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2693 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2694 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002695
2696 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2697 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002698 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2699 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2700 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2701 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2702
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002703 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2704 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2705 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2706 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2707 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2708 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2709 parameter.
2710
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002711 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2712
2713 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2714 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2715 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2716 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2717 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2718 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2719 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2720 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2721 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2722 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2723 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2724 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002725
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002726 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2727 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2728 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002729
2730 See also : "balance", "server"
2731
2732
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002733http-check disable-on-404
2734 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002736 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002737 Arguments : none
2738
2739 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2740 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2741 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2742 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2743 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2744 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2745 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2746 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002747 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2748 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2749 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2750
2751 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2752
2753
2754http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002755 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002757 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002758 Arguments :
2759 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2760 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002761 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002762 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2763 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2764 details on the supported keywords.
2765
2766 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2767 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2768 with the usual backslash ('\').
2769
2770 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2771 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2772 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2773 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2774 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2775
2776 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002777 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002778 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2779 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2780 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2781
2782 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002783 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002784 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2785 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2786 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2787 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2788
2789 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002790 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002791 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2792 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2793 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2794 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2795 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2796 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2797 trace).
2798
2799 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002800 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002801 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2802 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2803 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2804 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2805 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2806 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2807
2808 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2809 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2810 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2811 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2812 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2813 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2814 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2815 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2816
2817 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2818 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2819
2820 Examples :
2821 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002822 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002823
2824 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002825 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002826
2827 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002828 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002829
2830 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002831 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002832
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002833 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002834
2835
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002836http-check send-state
2837 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2839 yes | no | yes | yes
2840 Arguments : none
2841
2842 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2843 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2844 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2845 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2846 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2847
2848 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2849 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2850 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2851 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2852 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2853 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2854 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2855 checked in multiple backends.
2856
2857 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2858 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2859
2860 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2861 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2862 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2863 one fails.
2864
2865 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2866 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2867 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2868
2869 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2870 server's queue.
2871
2872 Example of a header received by the application server :
2873 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2874 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2875
2876 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2877
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002878http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002879 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002880 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002881 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
2882 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002883 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
2884 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2885 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2886 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2887 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
2888 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002889 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002890 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2891
2892 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2893 no | yes | yes | yes
2894
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002895 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2896 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2897 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2898 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2899 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002900
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002901 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2902 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2903 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2904
2905 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2906 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2907 are evaluated.
2908
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002909 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2910 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2911 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2912 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2913 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2914 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2915 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2916 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2917 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002918 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002919 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2920
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002921 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2922 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2923 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2924 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2925 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2926
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002927 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2928 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2929 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002930 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2931 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002932
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002933 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2934 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2935 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2936 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2937 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2938 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2939 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2940 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2941
2942 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2943 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2944 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2945 external users.
2946
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002947 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
2948 <name>.
2949
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002950 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
2951 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
2952 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
2953 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
2954 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
2955 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
2956 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
2957 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
2958
2959 Example:
2960
2961 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
2962
2963 applied to:
2964
2965 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
2966
2967 outputs:
2968
2969 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
2970
2971 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
2972
2973 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
2974 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
2975 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
2976 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
2977 header.
2978
2979 Example:
2980
2981 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
2982
2983 applied to:
2984
2985 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
2986
2987 outputs:
2988
2989 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
2990
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002991 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2992 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2993 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2994 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2995 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2996 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2997 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2998 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2999
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003000 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3001 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3002 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3003 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3004 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3005 another equipment.
3006
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003007 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3008 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3009 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3010 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3011 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3012 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3013 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3014 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3015
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003016 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3017 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3018 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3019 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3020 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3021 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3022 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3023 admin privileges.
3024
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003025 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3026 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3027 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3028 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3029 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3030 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3031 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3032 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3033
3034 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3035 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3036 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3037 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3038 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3039 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3040
3041 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3042 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3043 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3044 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3045 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3046 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3047
3048 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3049 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3050 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3051 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3052 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3053 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3054 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3055 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3056 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3057
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003058 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3059
3060 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3061 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3062 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3063 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003064
3065 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003066 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3067 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3068 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003069
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003070 http-request allow if nagios
3071 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3072 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3073 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003074
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003075 Example:
3076 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003077 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003078
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003079 Example:
3080 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3081 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3082 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3083 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3084 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3085 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3086 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3087 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3088 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3089
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003090 Example:
3091 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3092 acl add path /addacl
3093 acl del path /delacl
3094
3095 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3096
3097 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3098 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3099
3100 Example:
3101 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3102 acl setmap path /setmap
3103 acl delmap path /delmap
3104
3105 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3106
3107 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3108 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3109
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003110 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3111 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003112
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003113http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003114 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003115 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3116 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003117 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3118 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3119 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3120 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3121 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
3122 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003123 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003124 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3125
3126 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3127 no | yes | yes | yes
3128
3129 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3130 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3131 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3132 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3133 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3134 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3135
3136 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3137 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3138 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3139 current section.
3140
3141 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3142 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3143 rules are evaluated.
3144
3145 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3146 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3147 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3148 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3149 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3150 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3151 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3152
3153 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3154 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3155 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3156 external users.
3157
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003158 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3159 <name>.
3160
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003161 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3162 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3163 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3164 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3165 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3166 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3167 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3168 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3169
3170 Example:
3171
3172 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3173
3174 applied to:
3175
3176 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3177
3178 outputs:
3179
3180 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3181
3182 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3183
3184 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3185 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3186 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3187 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3188 header.
3189
3190 Example:
3191
3192 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3193
3194 applied to:
3195
3196 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3197
3198 outputs:
3199
3200 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3201
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003202 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3203 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3204 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3205 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3206 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3207 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3208 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3209 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3210
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003211 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3212 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3213 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3214 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3215 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3216 another equipment.
3217
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003218 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3219 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3220 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3221 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3222 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3223 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3224 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3225 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3226
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003227 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3228 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3229 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3230 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3231 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3232 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3233 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3234 admin privileges.
3235
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003236 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3237 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3238 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3239 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3240 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3241 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3242 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3243 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3244
3245 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3246 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3247 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3248 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3249 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3250 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3251
3252 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3253 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3254 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3255 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3256 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3257 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3258
3259 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3260 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3261 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3262 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3263 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3264 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3265 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3266 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3267 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3268
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003269 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3270
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003271 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003272 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3273 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3274 rules.
3275
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003276 Example:
3277 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3278
3279 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3280
3281 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3282 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3283
3284 Example:
3285 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3286
3287 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3288
3289 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3290 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3291
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003292 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3293 ACL usage.
3294
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003295
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003296http-send-name-header [<header>]
3297 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3298
3299 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3300 yes | no | yes | yes
3301
3302 Arguments :
3303
3304 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3305
3306 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3307 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3308 is added with the header string proved.
3309
3310 See also : "server"
3311
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003312id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003313 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3315 no | yes | yes | yes
3316 Arguments : none
3317
3318 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3319 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3320 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003321
3322
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003323ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3324 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3325 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3326 no | yes | yes | yes
3327
3328 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3329 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3330 and running).
3331
3332 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3333 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3334 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003335 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003336 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3337
3338 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3339 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3340
3341 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3342 "unless" condition is met.
3343
3344 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3345
3346
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003347log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003348log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003349no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003350 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3352 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003353
3354 Prefix :
3355 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3356 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3357 prefix does not allow arguments.
3358
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003359 Arguments :
3360 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3361 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3362 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3363 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3364 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3365 parameter.
3366
3367 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3368 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3369
3370 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3371 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3372 standard syslog port).
3373
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003374 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3375 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3376 standard syslog port).
3377
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003378 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3379 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3380 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3381 appropriately writeable).
3382
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003383 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3384 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3385 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3386 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3387
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003388 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3389
3390 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3391 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3392 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3393
3394 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3395 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3396 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003397 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3398 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3399 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3400 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3401 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003402
3403 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3404
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003405 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3406 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3407 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003408
3409 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3410 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3411 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3412 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3413
3414 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3415 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003416
3417 Example :
3418 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003419 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3420 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003421 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3422
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003423
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003424log-format <string>
3425 Allows you to custom a log line.
3426
3427 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3428
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003429
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003430max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3431 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3432 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3433 yes | no | yes | yes
3434
3435 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3436 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3437 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3438 servers.
3439
3440 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3441 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3442 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3443 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3444 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3445 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3446 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3447 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3448 picking a different server.
3449
3450 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3451 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3452 even if they have to be queued.
3453
3454 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3455 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3456
3457
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003458maxconn <conns>
3459 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3461 yes | yes | yes | no
3462 Arguments :
3463 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3464 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3465 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3466 closes.
3467
3468 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3469 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3470 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3471 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3472 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3473 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3474 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3475 properly tuned.
3476
3477 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3478 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3479 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3480
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003481 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3482
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003483 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3484
3485
3486mode { tcp|http|health }
3487 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3489 yes | yes | yes | yes
3490 Arguments :
3491 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3492 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3493 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3494 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3495
3496 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3497 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3498 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3499 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3500 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3501
3502 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003503 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3504 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3505 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3506 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3507 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3508 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3509 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003510
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003511 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3512 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3513 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003514
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003515 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003516 defaults http_instances
3517 mode http
3518
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003519 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003520
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003521
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003522monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003523 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3525 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003526 Arguments :
3527 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3528 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003529 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003530 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3531 backend and its backup.
3532
3533 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3534 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3535 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3536 servers in a list of backends.
3537
3538 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3539 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3540 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3541 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3542 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3543 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3544 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003545 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3546 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003547
3548 Example:
3549 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003550 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003551 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3552 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3553 monitor-uri /site_alive
3554 monitor fail if site_dead
3555
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003556 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003557
3558
3559monitor-net <source>
3560 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3562 yes | yes | yes | no
3563 Arguments :
3564 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3565 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3566 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3567 followed by a mask.
3568
3569 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3570 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003571 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003572 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3573
3574 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3575 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3576 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3577 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003578 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3579 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3580 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003581
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003582 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3583 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3584 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3585 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3586 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3587 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003588
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003589 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3590 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003591
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003592 Example :
3593 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3594 frontend www
3595 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3596
3597 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3598
3599
3600monitor-uri <uri>
3601 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3603 yes | yes | yes | no
3604 Arguments :
3605 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3606 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3607
3608 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3609 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3610 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3611 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3612 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3613 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3614 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3615 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3616
3617 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3618 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3619 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3620 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3621 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3622 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3623
3624 Example :
3625 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3626 frontend www
3627 mode http
3628 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3629
3630 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3631
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003632
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003633option abortonclose
3634no option abortonclose
3635 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3637 yes | no | yes | yes
3638 Arguments : none
3639
3640 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3641 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3642 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3643 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003644 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003645 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3646 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3647 encountered while delivering the response.
3648
3649 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3650 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3651 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3652 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3653 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3654 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003655 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003656 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003657 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003658 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3659 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3660 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3661
3662 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3663 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3664 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3665 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3666 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3667 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3668 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3669 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003670 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003671
3672 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3673 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3674
3675 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3676
3677
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003678option accept-invalid-http-request
3679no option accept-invalid-http-request
3680 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3682 yes | yes | yes | no
3683 Arguments : none
3684
3685 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3686 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3687 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3688 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3689 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3690 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3691 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3692 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003693 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3694 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3695 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3696 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3697 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3698 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003699
3700 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3701 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3702 been confirmed.
3703
3704 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3705 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003706 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3707 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003708 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3709
3710 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3711 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3712
3713 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3714 stats socket.
3715
3716
3717option accept-invalid-http-response
3718no option accept-invalid-http-response
3719 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3721 yes | no | yes | yes
3722 Arguments : none
3723
3724 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3725 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3726 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3727 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3728 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3729 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3730 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3731 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3732 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3733
3734 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3735 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3736 been confirmed.
3737
3738 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3739 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3740 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3741 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3742
3743 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3744 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3745
3746 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3747 stats socket.
3748
3749
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003750option allbackups
3751no option allbackups
3752 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3754 yes | no | yes | yes
3755 Arguments : none
3756
3757 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3758 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3759 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3760 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3761 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3762 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3763 order between the backup servers anymore.
3764
3765 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3766 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3767
3768 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3769 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3770
3771
3772option checkcache
3773no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003774 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3776 yes | no | yes | yes
3777 Arguments : none
3778
3779 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3780 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003781 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003782 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3783 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003784 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003785
3786 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003787 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003788 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003789 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3790 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003791 to the client are :
3792 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003793 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003794 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003795 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3796 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3797 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3798 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3799 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3800 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3801 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3802 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3803 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3804 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3805 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3806
3807 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003808 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003809 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003810 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003811 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3812
3813 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3814 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003815 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003816 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3817
3818 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3819 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3820
3821
3822option clitcpka
3823no option clitcpka
3824 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3826 yes | yes | yes | no
3827 Arguments : none
3828
3829 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3830 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3831 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3832 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3833
3834 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3835 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3836 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3837 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3838
3839 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3840 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3841 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3842 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3843 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3844
3845 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3846
3847 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3848 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3849 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3850
3851 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3852 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3853
3854 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3855
3856
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003857option contstats
3858 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3860 yes | yes | yes | no
3861 Arguments : none
3862
3863 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3864 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3865 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3866 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3867 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3868 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3869 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3870
3871
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003872option dontlog-normal
3873no option dontlog-normal
3874 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3876 yes | yes | yes | no
3877 Arguments : none
3878
3879 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3880 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3881 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3882 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3883 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3884 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3885 logged.
3886
3887 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3888 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3889 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3890
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003891 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003892 logging.
3893
3894
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003895option dontlognull
3896no option dontlognull
3897 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3899 yes | yes | yes | no
3900 Arguments : none
3901
3902 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3903 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3904 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3905 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3906 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3907 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3908 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3909
3910 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3911 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3912 would not be logged.
3913
3914 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3915 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3916
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003917 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003918
3919
3920option forceclose
3921no option forceclose
3922 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003924 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003925 Arguments : none
3926
3927 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3928 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3929 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3930 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3931 global session times in the logs.
3932
3933 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003934 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003935 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003936
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003937 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3938 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3939 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3940
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003941 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
3942 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003943
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003944 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3945 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3946
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003947 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003948
3949
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003950option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003951 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3953 yes | yes | yes | yes
3954 Arguments :
3955 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3956 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003957 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003958 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003959
3960 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3961 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3962 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3963 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3964 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3965 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3966 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003967 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3968 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3969 possible that the client has already brought one.
3970
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003971 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003972 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003973 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3974 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003975 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3976 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003977
3978 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3979 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3980 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3981 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3982 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3983 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3984 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3985
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003986 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3987 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3988 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3989 are under the control of the end-user.
3990
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003991 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003992 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3993 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003994 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3995 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3996 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003997
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003998 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003999 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4000 frontend www
4001 mode http
4002 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4003
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004004 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4005 backend www
4006 mode http
4007 option forwardfor header X-Client
4008
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004009 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004010 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004011
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004012
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004013option http-keep-alive
4014no option http-keep-alive
4015 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4017 yes | yes | yes | yes
4018 Arguments : none
4019
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004020 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4021 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4022 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4023 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4024 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4025 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4026 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4027
4028 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4029 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004030 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4031 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4032 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4033 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4034 situations where this option may be useful :
4035
4036 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4037 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4038
4039 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4040 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4041
4042 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4043 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4044 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4045 request.
4046
4047 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4048 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004049 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4050 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4051 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004052
4053 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4054 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4055
4056 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4057 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4058 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4059 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4060 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4061 not set.
4062
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004063 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4064 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004065 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004066 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004067
4068 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004069 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4070 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004071
4072
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004073option http-no-delay
4074no option http-no-delay
4075 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4077 yes | yes | yes | yes
4078 Arguments : none
4079
4080 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4081 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4082 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4083 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4084 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4085 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4086 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4087 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4088 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4089 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4090 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4091 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4092 affected.
4093
4094 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4095 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4096 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4097 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4098 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4099 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4100 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4101 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4102 latency environments.
4103
4104
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004105option http-pretend-keepalive
4106no option http-pretend-keepalive
4107 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4109 yes | yes | yes | yes
4110 Arguments : none
4111
4112 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4113 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4114 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4115 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4116 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4117 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4118 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4119 consider the response complete.
4120
4121 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4122 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4123 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4124 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4125 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4126 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4127
4128 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4129 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4130 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4131 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4132 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4133 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4134 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4135
4136 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4137 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004138 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004139 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4140 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004141
4142 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4143 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4144
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004145 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4146 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004147
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004148
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004149option http-server-close
4150no option http-server-close
4151 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4153 yes | yes | yes | yes
4154 Arguments : none
4155
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004156 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4157 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4158 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4159 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4160 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4161 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4162 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4163 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4164 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4165 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4166 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4167 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4168 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4169 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4170 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4171 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004172
4173 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4174 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4175 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4176 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004177 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4178 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004179
4180 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4181 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004182 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4183 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004184 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4185 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004186
4187 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4188 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4189
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004190 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004191 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4192 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004193
4194
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004195option http-tunnel
4196no option http-tunnel
4197 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4199 yes | yes | yes | yes
4200 Arguments : none
4201
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004202 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4203 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4204 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4205 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4206 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4207 "option http-tunnel".
4208
4209 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004210 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004211 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4212 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4213 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4214 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4215 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4216 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4217 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004218
4219 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4220 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4221
4222 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4223 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4224 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4225
4226
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004227option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004228no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004229 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4230 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4231 yes | yes | yes | no
4232 Arguments : none
4233
4234 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4235 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4236 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4237 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4238 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4239 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4240 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4241
4242 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4243 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4244 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4245 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4246 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4247 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4248 request along its whole life.
4249
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004250 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4251 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4252 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4253 front of an existing proxy.
4254
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004255 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4256
4257 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4258 http-server-close".
4259
4260
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004261option httpchk
4262option httpchk <uri>
4263option httpchk <method> <uri>
4264option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4265 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4267 yes | no | yes | yes
4268 Arguments :
4269 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4270 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4271 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4272 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4273 ones.
4274
4275 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4276 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4277 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4278
4279 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4280 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4281 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4282 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4283 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4284
4285 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4286 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4287 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4288 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4289 the lack of any response.
4290
4291 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4292
4293 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4294 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4295 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4296
4297 Examples :
4298 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4299 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4300 backend https_relay
4301 mode tcp
4302 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4303 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4304
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004305 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4306 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4307 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004308
4309
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004310option httpclose
4311no option httpclose
4312 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4314 yes | yes | yes | yes
4315 Arguments : none
4316
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004317 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4318 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4319 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4320 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004321 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004322 "option http-tunnel".
4323
4324 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4325 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4326 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4327 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4328 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4329 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4330 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4331 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004332
4333 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004334 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004335 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4336 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4337 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4338 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4339 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004340
4341 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4342 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004343 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4344 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004345 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4346 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004347
4348 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4349 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4350
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004351 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4352 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004353
4354
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004355option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004356 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4358 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004359 Arguments :
4360 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4361 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4362 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4363 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4364 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004365
4366 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4367 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4368 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4369 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4370 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4371 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4372 ports.
4373
4374 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4375
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004376 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4377 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
4378 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
4379 by default.
4380
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004381 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004382
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004383
4384option http_proxy
4385no option http_proxy
4386 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4388 yes | yes | yes | yes
4389 Arguments : none
4390
4391 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4392 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4393 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4394 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4395 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4396
4397 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4398 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4399 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4400 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004401 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004402 be analyzed.
4403
4404 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4405 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4406
4407 Example :
4408 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4409 backend direct_forward
4410 option httpclose
4411 option http_proxy
4412
4413 See also : "option httpclose"
4414
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004415
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004416option independent-streams
4417no option independent-streams
4418 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4420 yes | yes | yes | yes
4421 Arguments : none
4422
4423 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4424 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4425 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4426 receive data or not.
4427
4428 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4429 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4430 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4431 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4432 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4433 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4434 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4435 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4436 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4437 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4438 socket buffers.
4439
4440 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4441 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4442 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4443 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4444 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4445
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004446 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004447 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4448 deprecated.
4449
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004450 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004451
4452
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004453option ldap-check
4454 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4456 yes | no | yes | yes
4457 Arguments : none
4458
4459 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4460 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4461 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4462 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4463
4464 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4465 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4466
4467 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4468 configure it.
4469
4470 Example :
4471 option ldap-check
4472
4473 See also : "option httpchk"
4474
4475
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004476option log-health-checks
4477no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004478 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4480 yes | no | yes | yes
4481 Arguments : none
4482
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004483 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4484 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4485 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004486
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004487 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
4488 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
4489 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
4490 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
4491 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
4492
4493 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
4494 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004495
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004496 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
4497 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
4498 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004499
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004500
4501option log-separate-errors
4502no option log-separate-errors
4503 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4504 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4505 yes | yes | yes | no
4506 Arguments : none
4507
4508 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4509 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4510 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4511 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4512 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4513 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4514 provides very important information.
4515
4516 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4517 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4518 error logs.
4519
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004520 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004521 logging.
4522
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004523
4524option logasap
4525no option logasap
4526 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4528 yes | yes | yes | no
4529 Arguments : none
4530
4531 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4532 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4533 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4534 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4535 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4536 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4537 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004538 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004539 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4540 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4541
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004542 Examples :
4543 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4544 mode http
4545 option httplog
4546 option logasap
4547 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4548
4549 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4550 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4551 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4552 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4553
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004554 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004555 logging.
4556
4557
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004558option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004559 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4561 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004562 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004563 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4564 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004565 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004566
4567 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4568 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4569 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4570 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4571 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4572 in the MySQL table, like this :
4573
4574 USE mysql;
4575 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4576 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4577
4578 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4579 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4580 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4581 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4582 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4583 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4584 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4585 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4586 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4587
4588 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4589 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004590
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004591 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004592
4593 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4594 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4595 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4596 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4597 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4598 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4599
4600 See also: "option httpchk"
4601
4602
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004603option nolinger
4604no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004605 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004606 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4607 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004608 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004609
4610 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4611 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4612 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4613 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4614 connections.
4615
4616 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4617 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4618 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4619 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4620 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4621 this too.
4622
4623 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4624 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4625 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4626
4627 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4628 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4629 for servers.
4630
4631 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4632 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4633
4634
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004635option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4636 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4638 yes | yes | yes | yes
4639 Arguments :
4640 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4641 matching <network>
4642 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4643 header name.
4644
4645 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4646 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4647 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4648 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4649 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4650 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4651 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4652 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4653 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4654 possible that the client has already brought one.
4655
4656 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4657 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4658 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4659 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4660 header and requires different one.
4661
4662 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4663 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4664 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4665 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4666 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4667 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4668 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4669
4670 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4671 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4672 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4673 both are defined.
4674
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004675 Examples :
4676 # Original Destination address
4677 frontend www
4678 mode http
4679 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4680
4681 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4682 backend www
4683 mode http
4684 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4685
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004686 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4687 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004688
4689
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004690option persist
4691no option persist
4692 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4693 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4694 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004695 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004696
4697 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4698 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4699 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4700 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4701 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4702 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4703 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4704 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4705 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4706 redirected to another valid server.
4707
4708 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4709 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4710
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004711 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004712
4713
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004714option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4715 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4717 yes | no | yes | yes
4718 Arguments :
4719 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4720 PostgreSQL server.
4721
4722 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4723 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4724 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4725 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4726
4727 See also: "option httpchk"
4728
4729
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004730option prefer-last-server
4731no option prefer-last-server
4732 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4733 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4734 yes | no | yes | yes
4735 Arguments : none
4736
4737 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4738 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4739 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4740 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4741 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4742 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4743 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4744 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4745 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004746 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4747 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4748 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4749 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4750 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4751 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4752 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004753
4754 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4755 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4756
4757 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4758
4759
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004760option redispatch
4761no option redispatch
4762 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4763 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4764 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004765 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004766
4767 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4768 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4769 be able to access the service anymore.
4770
4771 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4772 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4773
4774 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4775 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4776 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004777
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004778 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4779 "redisp" keywords.
4780
4781 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4782 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4783
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004784 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004785
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004786
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004787option redis-check
4788 Use redis health checks for server testing
4789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4790 yes | no | yes | yes
4791 Arguments : none
4792
4793 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4794 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4795 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4796 find the "+PONG" response message.
4797
4798 Example :
4799 option redis-check
4800
4801 See also : "option httpchk"
4802
4803
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004804option smtpchk
4805option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4806 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4808 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004809 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004810 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4811 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4812 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4813
4814 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4815 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4816 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4817
4818 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4819 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4820 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4821 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4822 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4823 dead server.
4824
4825 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4826 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4827 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4828 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4829
4830 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4831 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4832 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4833 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4834 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4835
4836 Example :
4837 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4838
4839 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4840
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004841
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004842option socket-stats
4843no option socket-stats
4844
4845 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4847 yes | yes | yes | no
4848
4849 Arguments : none
4850
4851
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004852option splice-auto
4853no option splice-auto
4854 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4856 yes | yes | yes | yes
4857 Arguments : none
4858
4859 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4860 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4861 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4862 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004863 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004864 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4865 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4866 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4867 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4868
4869 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4870 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4871 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4872 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4873 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4874 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4875 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4876 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4877 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4878 keyword.
4879
4880 Example :
4881 option splice-auto
4882
4883 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4884 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4885
4886 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4887 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4888
4889
4890option splice-request
4891no option splice-request
4892 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4894 yes | yes | yes | yes
4895 Arguments : none
4896
4897 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004898 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004899 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4900 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4901 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4902 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4903
4904 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4905
4906 Example :
4907 option splice-request
4908
4909 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4910 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4911
4912 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4913 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4914
4915
4916option splice-response
4917no option splice-response
4918 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4920 yes | yes | yes | yes
4921 Arguments : none
4922
4923 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004924 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004925 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4926 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4927 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4928 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4929
4930 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4931
4932 Example :
4933 option splice-response
4934
4935 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4936 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4937
4938 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4939 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4940
4941
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004942option srvtcpka
4943no option srvtcpka
4944 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4946 yes | no | yes | yes
4947 Arguments : none
4948
4949 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4950 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4951 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4952 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4953
4954 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4955 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4956 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4957 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4958
4959 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4960 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4961 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4962 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4963 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4964
4965 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4966
4967 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4968 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4969 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4970
4971 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4972 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4973
4974 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4975
4976
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004977option ssl-hello-chk
4978 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4980 yes | no | yes | yes
4981 Arguments : none
4982
4983 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4984 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4985 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4986 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4987 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4988 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4989 hello message.
4990
4991 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4992 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4993 messages, which is appreciable.
4994
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004995 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4996 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4997 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004998
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004999 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5000
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005001
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005002option tcp-check
5003 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5004 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5005 yes | no | yes | yes
5006
5007 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5008 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5009
5010 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5011 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5012 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5013
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005014 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005015 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5016 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5017 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5018 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5019 only.
5020
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005021 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005022 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5023 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5024 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5025 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5026
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005027 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005028 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5029 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005030 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005031 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5032 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5033 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5034 the respective protocols.
5035 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5036 analysed.
5037
5038 Examples :
5039 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5040 option tcp-check
5041 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
5042
5043 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5044 option tcp-check
5045 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
5046
5047 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5048 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005049 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005050 option tcp-check
5051 tcp-check send PING\r\n
5052 tcp-check expect +PONG
5053 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5054 tcp-check expect string role:master
5055 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5056 tcp-check expect string +OK
5057
5058 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5059 (send many headers before analyzing)
5060 option tcp-check
5061 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5062 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5063 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5064 tcp-check send \r\n
5065 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
5066
5067
5068 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5069
5070
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005071option tcp-smart-accept
5072no option tcp-smart-accept
5073 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5075 yes | yes | yes | no
5076 Arguments : none
5077
5078 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5079 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5080 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5081 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5082 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5083 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5084
5085 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5086 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5087 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5088 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5089
5090 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5091 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5092 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5093 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5094
5095 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5096 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5097 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5098
5099 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5100 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5101 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5102
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005103 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5104
5105
5106option tcp-smart-connect
5107no option tcp-smart-connect
5108 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5110 yes | no | yes | yes
5111 Arguments : none
5112
5113 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5114 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5115 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5116 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5117 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5118
5119 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5120 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5121 complex.
5122
5123 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5124 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5125 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5126
5127 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5128 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5129
5130 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5131
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005132
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005133option tcpka
5134 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5136 yes | yes | yes | yes
5137 Arguments : none
5138
5139 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5140 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5141 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5142 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5143
5144 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5145 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5146 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5147 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5148
5149 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5150 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5151 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5152 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5153 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5154
5155 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5156
5157 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5158 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5159 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5160 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5161 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5162 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5163 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5164 backends.
5165
5166 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5167
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005168
5169option tcplog
5170 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5172 yes | yes | yes | yes
5173 Arguments : none
5174
5175 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5176 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5177 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5178 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5179 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5180 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5181 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5182 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5183
5184 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5185
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005186 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005187
5188
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005189option transparent
5190no option transparent
5191 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005193 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005194 Arguments : none
5195
5196 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5197 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5198 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5199 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5200 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5201 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5202 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5203 appropriate server.
5204
5205 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5206 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5207
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005208 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005209 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005210
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005211
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005212persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005213persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005214 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5216 yes | no | yes | yes
5217 Arguments :
5218 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005219 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5220 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005221
5222 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5223 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5224 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5225 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5226 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5227 forwarded to this server.
5228
5229 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5230 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5231 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005232 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005233 a single "listen" section.
5234
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005235 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5236 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5237 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5238
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005239 Example :
5240 listen tse-farm
5241 bind :3389
5242 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5243 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5244 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5245 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5246 persist rdp-cookie
5247 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005248 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005249 balance rdp-cookie
5250 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5251 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5252
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005253 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5254 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005255
5256
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005257rate-limit sessions <rate>
5258 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5260 yes | yes | yes | no
5261 Arguments :
5262 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5263 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5264
5265 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5266 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5267 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5268 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5269 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5270 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5271
5272 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5273 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5274 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5275 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5276
5277 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5278 listen smtp
5279 mode tcp
5280 bind :25
5281 rate-limit sessions 10
5282 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5283
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005284 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5285 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5286 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005287
5288 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5289
5290
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005291redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5292redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5293redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005294 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5296 no | yes | yes | yes
5297
5298 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005299 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005300
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005301 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005302 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005303 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5304 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5305 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005306
5307 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5308 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5309 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5310 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5311 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005312 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5313 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5314 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5315 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005316
5317 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5318 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5319 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5320 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5321 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5322 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005323 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005324 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005325 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5326 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5327 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005328
5329 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005330 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5331 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5332 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5333 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5334 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5335 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5336 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5337 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005338
5339 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5340 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5341
5342 - "drop-query"
5343 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5344 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5345 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5346 with a location-type redirect.
5347
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005348 - "append-slash"
5349 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5350 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5351 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5352 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5353
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005354 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5355 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5356 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5357 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5358 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5359 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5360 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5361
5362 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5363 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5364 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5365 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5366 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5367 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5368 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005369
5370 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5371 acl clear dst_port 80
5372 acl secure dst_port 8080
5373 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005374 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005375 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005376 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5377
5378 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005379 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5380 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5381 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005382 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005383
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005384 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5385 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5386 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5387
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005388 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005389 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005390
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005391 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5392 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5393 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5394
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005395 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005396
5397
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005398redisp (deprecated)
5399redispatch (deprecated)
5400 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5401 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5402 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005403 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005404
5405 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5406 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5407 be able to access the service anymore.
5408
5409 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5410 redistribute them to a working server.
5411
5412 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5413 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5414 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005415
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005416 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5417 "option redispatch" instead.
5418
5419 See also : "option redispatch"
5420
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005421
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005422reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005423 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5425 no | yes | yes | yes
5426 Arguments :
5427 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5428 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005429 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005430
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005431 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5432 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5433
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005434 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5435 the last header of an HTTP request.
5436
5437 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5438 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5439 responses.
5440
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005441 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5442 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5443 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5444
5445 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5446 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005447
5448
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005449reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5450reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005451 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5452 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5453 no | yes | yes | yes
5454 Arguments :
5455 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5456 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5457 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5458 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5459 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5460 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5461 ignores case.
5462
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005463 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5464 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5465
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005466 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5467 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5468 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5469 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005470 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005471
5472 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5473 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5474
5475 Example :
5476 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5477 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5478 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5479
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005480 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5481 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005482
5483
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005484reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5485reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005486 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5488 no | yes | yes | yes
5489 Arguments :
5490 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5491 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5492 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5493 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5494 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5495 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5496
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005497 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5498 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5499
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005500 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5501 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5502 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5503 next servers.
5504
5505 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5506 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5507 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5508
5509 Example :
5510 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5511 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5512 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5513
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005514 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5515 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005516
5517
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005518reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5519reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005520 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5522 no | yes | yes | yes
5523 Arguments :
5524 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5525 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5526 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5527 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5528 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5529 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5530 case.
5531
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005532 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5533 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5534
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005535 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5536 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5537 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5538 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005539 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005540
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005541 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005542 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005543 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005544
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005545 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5546 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5547
5548 Example :
5549 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5550 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5551 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5552
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005553 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5554 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005555
5556
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005557reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5558reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005559 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5561 no | yes | yes | yes
5562 Arguments :
5563 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5564 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5565 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5566 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5567 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5568 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5569 case.
5570
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005571 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5572 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5573
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005574 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5575 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5576 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5577 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5578
5579 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5580 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5581
5582 Example :
5583 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5584 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5585 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5586 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5587
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005588 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5589 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005590
5591
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005592reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5593reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005594 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5596 no | yes | yes | yes
5597 Arguments :
5598 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5599 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5600 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5601 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5602 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5603 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5604
5605 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5606 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5607 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5608 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005609 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005610
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005611 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5612 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5613
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005614 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5615 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5616 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5617
5618 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5619 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5620 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5621 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5622 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5623
5624 Example :
5625 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005626 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005627 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5628 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5629
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005630 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5631 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005632
5633
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005634reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5635reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005636 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5638 no | yes | yes | yes
5639 Arguments :
5640 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5641 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5642 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5643 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5644 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5645 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5646 ignores case.
5647
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005648 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5649 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5650
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005651 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5652 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005653 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5654 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5655 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005656 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5657 not set.
5658
5659 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5660 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5661 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5662 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5663 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5664
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005665 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005666 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5667 # block all others.
5668 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5669 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5670
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005671 # block bad guys
5672 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5673 reqitarpit . if badguys
5674
5675 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5676 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005677
5678
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005679retries <value>
5680 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5681 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5682 yes | no | yes | yes
5683 Arguments :
5684 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5685 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5686 default value is 3.
5687
5688 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5689 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5690 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5691
5692 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5693 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5694
5695 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5696 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5697
5698 See also : "option redispatch"
5699
5700
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005701rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005702 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5704 no | yes | yes | yes
5705 Arguments :
5706 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5707 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005708 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005709
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005710 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5711 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5712
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005713 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5714 the last header of an HTTP response.
5715
5716 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5717 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5718 responses.
5719
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005720 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5721 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005722
5723
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005724rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5725rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005726 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5728 no | yes | yes | yes
5729 Arguments :
5730 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5731 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5732 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5733 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5734 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5735 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5736 ignores case.
5737
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005738 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5739 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5740
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005741 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5742 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005743 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005744 client.
5745
5746 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5747 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5748 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5749
5750 Example :
5751 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005752 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005753
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005754 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5755 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005756
5757
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005758rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5759rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005760 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5762 no | yes | yes | yes
5763 Arguments :
5764 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5765 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5766 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5767 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5768 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5769 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5770 ignores case.
5771
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005772 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5773 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5774
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005775 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5776 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5777 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5778 case-sensitive.
5779
5780 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005781 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5782 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5783 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005784
5785 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5786 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5787
5788 Example :
5789 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5790 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5791
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005792 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5793 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005794
5795
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005796rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5797rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005798 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5800 no | yes | yes | yes
5801 Arguments :
5802 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5803 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5804 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5805 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5806 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5807 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5808 ignores case.
5809
5810 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5811 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5812 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5813 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005814 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005815
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005816 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5817 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5818
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005819 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5820 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5821 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5822
5823 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5824 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5825 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5826 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5827 are not case-sensitive.
5828
5829 Example :
5830 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5831 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5832
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005833 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5834 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005835
5836
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005837server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005838 Declare a server in a backend
5839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5840 no | no | yes | yes
5841 Arguments :
5842 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005843 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005844 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005845
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005846 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5847 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5848 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5849 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005850 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5851 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5852 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5853 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5854 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005855 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5856 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5857 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5858 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5859 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5860 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5861 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005862 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005863 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5864 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5865 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5866 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005867
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005868 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005869 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5870 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5871 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5872 adding this value to the client's port.
5873
5874 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5875 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005876 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005877
5878 Examples :
5879 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5880 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005881 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005882 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5883 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5884 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005885
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005886 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5887 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005888
5889
5890source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005891source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005892source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005893 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5895 yes | no | yes | yes
5896 Arguments :
5897 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5898 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005899
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005900 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005901 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5902 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5903 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5904 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5905 supported prefixes are :
5906 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5907 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5908 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005909 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005910 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5911 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5912 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5913 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005914
5915 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5916 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005917 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5918 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5919 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005920
5921 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5922 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5923 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5924 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5925 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5926 <addr>.
5927
5928 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5929 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5930 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5931 port.
5932
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005933 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5934 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5935 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5936 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005937 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005938 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5939 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5940 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5941 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5942 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5943 HTTP header.
5944
5945 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5946 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005947 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005948 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5949 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5950 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5951 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5952 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5953 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5954 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5955
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005956 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5957 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5958 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5959 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5960 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5961 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5962
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005963 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5964 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5965 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5966 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5967
5968 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5969 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5970 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5971 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5972 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5973 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5974
5975 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5976 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5977 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5978 there are two methods :
5979
5980 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5981 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5982 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5983 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5984 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5985 of the client ranges may be used.
5986
5987 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5988 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5989 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5990 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5991 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5992 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5993 same session.
5994
5995 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5996 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5997 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5998 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5999 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6000 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6001
6002 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6003 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6004 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006005 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006006
6007 Examples :
6008 backend private
6009 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6010 source 192.168.1.200
6011
6012 backend transparent_ssl1
6013 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6014 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6015
6016 backend transparent_ssl2
6017 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6018 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6019 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6020
6021 backend transparent_ssl3
6022 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6023 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6024 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6025
6026 backend transparent_smtp
6027 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6028 # with Tproxy version 4.
6029 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6030
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006031 backend transparent_http
6032 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6033 # proxy.
6034 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6035
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006036 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006037 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6038
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006039
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006040srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6041 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6042 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6043 yes | no | yes | yes
6044 Arguments :
6045 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6046 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6047 as explained at the top of this document.
6048
6049 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6050 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6051 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6052 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6053 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6054 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6055 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6056
6057 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6058 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6059 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6060 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6061 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006062 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006063 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006064 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006065
6066 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6067 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6068 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6069 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6070 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6071 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6072
6073 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6074 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6075
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006076 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6077 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006078
6079
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006080stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6081 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6082 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006083 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006084
6085 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6086 matched.
6087
6088 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6089 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6090
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006091 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6092 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6093 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6094
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006095 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6096 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6097 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6098 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006099
6100 Example :
6101 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6102 backend stats_localhost
6103 stats enable
6104 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6105
6106 Example :
6107 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6108 backend stats_auth
6109 stats enable
6110 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6111 stats admin if TRUE
6112
6113 Example :
6114 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6115 userlist stats-auth
6116 group admin users admin
6117 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6118 group readonly users haproxy
6119 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6120
6121 backend stats_auth
6122 stats enable
6123 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6124 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6125 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6126 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6127
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006128 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6129 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6130 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006131
6132
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006133stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6134 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006136 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006137 Arguments :
6138 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6139
6140 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6141
6142 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6143 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6144 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6145 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6146 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6147 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6148
6149 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6150 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6151 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006152 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006153
6154 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6155 report using "stats scope".
6156
6157 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6158 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6159 unobvious parameters.
6160
6161 Example :
6162 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6163 backend public_www
6164 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6165 stats enable
6166 stats hide-version
6167 stats scope .
6168 stats uri /admin?stats
6169 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6170 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6171 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6172
6173 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6174 backend private_monitoring
6175 stats enable
6176 stats uri /admin?stats
6177 stats refresh 5s
6178
6179 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6180
6181
6182stats enable
6183 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006185 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006186 Arguments : none
6187
6188 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6189 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6190 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6191 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6192 - stats auth : no authentication
6193 - stats scope : no restriction
6194
6195 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6196 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6197 unobvious parameters.
6198
6199 Example :
6200 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6201 backend public_www
6202 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6203 stats enable
6204 stats hide-version
6205 stats scope .
6206 stats uri /admin?stats
6207 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6208 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6209 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6210
6211 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6212 backend private_monitoring
6213 stats enable
6214 stats uri /admin?stats
6215 stats refresh 5s
6216
6217 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6218
6219
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006220stats hide-version
6221 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006223 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006224 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006225
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006226 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6227 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6228 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6229 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6230 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6231 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006232
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006233 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6234 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6235 unobvious parameters.
6236
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006237 Example :
6238 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6239 backend public_www
6240 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006241 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006242 stats hide-version
6243 stats scope .
6244 stats uri /admin?stats
6245 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6246 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6247 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006248
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006249 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6250 backend private_monitoring
6251 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006252 stats uri /admin?stats
6253 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006254
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006255 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006256
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006257
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006258stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6259 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6260 Access control for statistics
6261
6262 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6263 no | no | yes | yes
6264
6265 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6266 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6267 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6268 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6269 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6270 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6271
6272 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6273 instance.
6274
6275 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6276 about ACL usage.
6277
6278
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006279stats realm <realm>
6280 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006282 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006283 Arguments :
6284 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6285 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6286 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6287
6288 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6289 using a backslash ('\').
6290
6291 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6292 only related to authentication.
6293
6294 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6295 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6296 unobvious parameters.
6297
6298 Example :
6299 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6300 backend public_www
6301 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6302 stats enable
6303 stats hide-version
6304 stats scope .
6305 stats uri /admin?stats
6306 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6307 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6308 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6309
6310 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6311 backend private_monitoring
6312 stats enable
6313 stats uri /admin?stats
6314 stats refresh 5s
6315
6316 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6317
6318
6319stats refresh <delay>
6320 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006322 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006323 Arguments :
6324 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6325 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6326 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6327 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6328 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6329 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6330
6331 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6332 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6333 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6334 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6335
6336 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6337 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6338 unobvious parameters.
6339
6340 Example :
6341 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6342 backend public_www
6343 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6344 stats enable
6345 stats hide-version
6346 stats scope .
6347 stats uri /admin?stats
6348 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6349 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6350 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6351
6352 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6353 backend private_monitoring
6354 stats enable
6355 stats uri /admin?stats
6356 stats refresh 5s
6357
6358 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6359
6360
6361stats scope { <name> | "." }
6362 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006364 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006365 Arguments :
6366 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6367 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6368 section in which the statement appears.
6369
6370 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6371 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6372 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6373 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6374 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6375 exists.
6376
6377 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6378 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6379 unobvious parameters.
6380
6381 Example :
6382 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6383 backend public_www
6384 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6385 stats enable
6386 stats hide-version
6387 stats scope .
6388 stats uri /admin?stats
6389 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6390 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6391 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6392
6393 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6394 backend private_monitoring
6395 stats enable
6396 stats uri /admin?stats
6397 stats refresh 5s
6398
6399 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6400
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006401
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006402stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006403 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006405 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006406
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006407 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006408 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6409
6410 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6411 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6412
6413 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6414 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006415 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006416
6417 Example :
6418 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6419 backend private_monitoring
6420 stats enable
6421 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6422 stats uri /admin?stats
6423 stats refresh 5s
6424
6425 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6426 global section.
6427
6428
6429stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006430 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6431 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6432 yes | yes | yes | yes
6433 Arguments : none
6434
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006435 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006436 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6437 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6438 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6439 - IP (socket, server)
6440 - cookie (backend, server)
6441
6442 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6443 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006444 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006445
6446 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6447
6448
6449stats show-node [ <name> ]
6450 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006452 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006453 Arguments:
6454 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6455 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6456
6457 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6458 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006459 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006460
6461 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6462 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6463 unobvious parameters.
6464
6465 Example:
6466 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6467 backend private_monitoring
6468 stats enable
6469 stats show-node Europe-1
6470 stats uri /admin?stats
6471 stats refresh 5s
6472
6473 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6474 section.
6475
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006476
6477stats uri <prefix>
6478 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006480 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006481 Arguments :
6482 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6483 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6484 query string.
6485
6486 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6487 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6488 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6489 possible to reach it in the application.
6490
6491 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006492 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006493 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6494 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6495 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6496 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6497
6498 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6499 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6500 an address or a port to statistics only.
6501
6502 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6503 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6504 unobvious parameters.
6505
6506 Example :
6507 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6508 backend public_www
6509 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6510 stats enable
6511 stats hide-version
6512 stats scope .
6513 stats uri /admin?stats
6514 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6515 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6516 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6517
6518 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6519 backend private_monitoring
6520 stats enable
6521 stats uri /admin?stats
6522 stats refresh 5s
6523
6524 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6525
6526
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006527stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6528 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006530 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006531
6532 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006533 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006534 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6535 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6536 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6537
6538 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6539 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6540 the "stick-table" statement.
6541
6542 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6543 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6544 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6545 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6546 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6547
6548 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6549 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6550 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6551 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6552 transformation rules.
6553
6554 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6555 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6556 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6557 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6558 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6559 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6560 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6561
6562 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6563 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6564 ACL based conditions.
6565
6566 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6567 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6568 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6569 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6570
6571 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6572 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6573 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6574 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6575
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006576 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6577 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6578 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6579
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006580 Example :
6581 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6582 # last 30 minutes
6583 backend pop
6584 mode tcp
6585 balance roundrobin
6586 stick store-request src
6587 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6588 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6589 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6590
6591 backend smtp
6592 mode tcp
6593 balance roundrobin
6594 stick match src table pop
6595 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6596 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6597
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006598 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006599 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006600
6601
6602stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6603 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6605 no | no | yes | yes
6606
6607 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6608 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6609 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6610 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6611
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006612 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6613 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6614 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6615
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006616 Examples :
6617 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006618 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006619
6620 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6621 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6622 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6623
6624
6625 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6626 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6627 backend http
6628 mode http
6629 balance roundrobin
6630 stick on src table https
6631 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6632 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6633 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6634
6635 backend https
6636 mode tcp
6637 balance roundrobin
6638 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6639 stick on src
6640 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6641 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6642
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006643 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006644
6645
6646stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6647 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6649 no | no | yes | yes
6650
6651 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006652 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006653 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6654 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6655 server is selected.
6656
6657 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6658 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6659 the "stick-table" statement.
6660
6661 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6662 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6663 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6664 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6665 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6666 address.
6667
6668 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6669 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6670 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6671 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6672 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6673 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6674 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6675 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6676 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6677 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6678
6679 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6680 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6681 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6682 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6683 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6684 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6685 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6686
6687 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6688 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6689 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6690 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6691
6692 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6693 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6694 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6695 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6696 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6697 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006698 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6699 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6700 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6701 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6702 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6703 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006704
6705 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6706 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6707 the request.
6708
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006709 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6710 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6711 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6712
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006713 Example :
6714 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6715 # last 30 minutes
6716 backend pop
6717 mode tcp
6718 balance roundrobin
6719 stick store-request src
6720 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6721 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6722 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6723
6724 backend smtp
6725 mode tcp
6726 balance roundrobin
6727 stick match src table pop
6728 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6729 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6730
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006731 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006732 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006733
6734
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006735stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006736 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6737 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006738 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006740 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006741
6742 Arguments :
6743 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6744 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6745 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6746 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6747
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006748 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6749 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6750 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6751 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6752
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006753 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6754 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6755 instance.
6756
6757 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6758 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6759 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6760 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6761 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6762 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006763 to 32 characters.
6764
6765 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6766 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6767 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006768 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006769 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6770 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006771
6772 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006773 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6774 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006775 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6776 increase.
6777
6778 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006779 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6780 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6781 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006782
6783 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6784 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6785 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6786 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6787 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6788 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6789 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6790 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6791 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6792 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6793 parameter (see below).
6794
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006795 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6796 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6797 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6798 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6799 soft restart.
6800
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006801 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6802
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006803 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6804 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6805 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6806 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6807 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006808 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006809 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6810 if not expiration delay is specified.
6811
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006812 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6813 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6814 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6815 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006816 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6817 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6818 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6819 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6820 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6821 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6822 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6823 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6824 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6825 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6826 types and their arguments.
6827
6828 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6829 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6830 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6831 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6832
6833 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6834 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6835 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6836 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6837
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006838 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6839 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6840 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6841 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6842 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6843 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6844
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006845 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6846 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6847 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6848 they were received.
6849
6850 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6851 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6852 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6853 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6854 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6855
6856 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6857 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6858 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6859 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6860 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6861
6862 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6863 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6864 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6865
6866 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6867 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6868 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6869 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6870 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6871
6872 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6873 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6874 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6875 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6876 the client side.
6877
6878 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6879 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6880 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6881 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6882 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6883 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6884 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6885
6886 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6887 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6888 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6889 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6890 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6891 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6892 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6893
6894 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6895 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6896 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6897 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6898 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6899 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6900
6901 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6902 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6903 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6904 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6905
6906 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6907 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6908 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6909 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6910 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6911 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6912 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6913 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6914 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6915 recommended for better fairness.
6916
6917 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6918 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6919 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6920 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6921
6922 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6923 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6924 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6925 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6926 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6927 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6928 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6929 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6930 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6931 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006932
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006933 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6934 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006935 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6936 reference it.
6937
6938 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6939 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6940 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6941 as an exclusive stickiness.
6942
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006943 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6944 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6945 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6946 something that can be ignored.
6947
6948 Example:
6949 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6950 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6951 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6952 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6953
6954 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006955 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006956
6957
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006958stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6959 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6961 no | no | yes | yes
6962
6963 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006964 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006965 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6966 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6967 server is selected.
6968
6969 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6970 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6971 the "stick-table" statement.
6972
6973 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6974 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6975 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6976 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6977
6978 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6979 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6980 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6981 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6982 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6983 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006984 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006985 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6986 rules.
6987
6988 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6989 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6990 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6991 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6992 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6993 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6994 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6995
6996 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6997 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6998 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6999 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7000
7001 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7002 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7003 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7004 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7005 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7006 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007007 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7008 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7009 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7010 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7011 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7012 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7013 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7014 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7015 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007016
7017 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7018
7019 Example :
7020 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7021 backend https
7022 mode tcp
7023 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007024 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007025 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007026
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007027 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7028 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7029
7030 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7031 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7032 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7033
7034 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7035 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007036
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007037 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7038 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7039 # at offset 44.
7040
7041 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7042 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7043
7044 # Learn on response if server hello.
7045 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007046
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007047 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7048 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7049
7050 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7051 extraction.
7052
7053
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007054tcp-check connect [params*]
7055 Opens a new connection
7056 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7057 no | no | yes | yes
7058
7059 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7060 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7061 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7062
7063 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7064 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7065 of the sequence.
7066
7067 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7068 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7069 do.
7070
7071 Parameters :
7072 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7073 use the TCP connection.
7074
7075 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7076 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7077 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7078
7079 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7080
7081 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7082
7083 Examples:
7084 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7085 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7086 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7087 option tcp-check
7088 tcp-check connect
7089 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7090 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7091 tcp-check send \r\n
7092 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7093 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7094 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7095 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7096 tcp-check send \r\n
7097 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7098 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7099
7100 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7101 option tcp-check
7102 tcp-check connect port 110
7103 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7104 tcp-check connect port 143
7105 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7106 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7107
7108 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7109
7110
7111tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7112 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7113 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7114 no | no | yes | yes
7115
7116 Arguments :
7117 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7118 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7119 binary.
7120 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7121 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7122 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7123
7124 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7125 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7126 with the usual backslash ('\').
7127 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7128 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7129 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7130 used upper or lower case.
7131
7132
7133 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7134
7135 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7136 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7137 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7138 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7139 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7140 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7141 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7142 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7143
7144 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7145 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7146 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7147 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7148 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7149 expression.
7150
7151 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7152 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7153 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7154 this exact hexadecimal string.
7155 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7156
7157 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7158 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7159 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7160 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7161 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7162 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7163 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7164 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7165 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7166 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7167 the null character.
7168
7169 Examples :
7170 # perform a POP check
7171 option tcp-check
7172 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7173
7174 # perform an IMAP check
7175 option tcp-check
7176 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7177
7178 # look for the redis master server
7179 option tcp-check
7180 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7181 tcp-check expect +PONG
7182 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7183 tcp-check expect string role:master
7184 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7185 tcp-check expect string +OK
7186
7187
7188 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7189 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7190
7191
7192tcp-check send <data>
7193 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7194 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7195 no | no | yes | yes
7196
7197 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7198 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7199
7200 Examples :
7201 # look for the redis master server
7202 option tcp-check
7203 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7204 tcp-check expect string role:master
7205
7206 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7207 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7208
7209
7210tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7211 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7212 tcp health check
7213 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7214 no | no | yes | yes
7215
7216 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7217 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7218 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7219 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7220 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7221 hexadecimal string.
7222 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7223
7224 Examples :
7225 # redis check in binary
7226 option tcp-check
7227 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7228 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7229
7230
7231 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7232 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7233
7234
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007235tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7236 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7238 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007239 Arguments :
7240 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007241 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7242 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007243
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007244 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007245
7246 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7247 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007248 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7249 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7250 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7251 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7252 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7253 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007254
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007255 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7256 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7257 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7258 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007259
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007260 Five types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007261 - accept :
7262 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7263 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7264 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007265
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007266 - reject :
7267 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7268 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7269 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7270 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7271 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7272 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7273 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7274 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7275 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7276 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7277 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7278 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007279
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007280 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7281 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7282 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7283 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7284 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7285 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7286 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7287 hosts.
7288
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007289 - capture <sample> len <length> :
7290 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
7291 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
7292 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
7293 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
7294 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
7295 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
7296 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
7297 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
7298 session life. Since it applies to Please check section 7.3 (Fetching
7299 samples) and "capture request header" for more information.
7300
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007301 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007302 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
7303 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
7304 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007305 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7306 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007307 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007308 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7309 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7310 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7311 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7312 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007313
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007314 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007315 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007316 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007317 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7318 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7319 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7320 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007321
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007322 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7323 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7324 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7325 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007326
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007327 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7328 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7329 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7330 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7331 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007332 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7333 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7334 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7335 layer7 information is extracted.
7336
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007337 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7338 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7339 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7340 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7341 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007342
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007343 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7344 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7345 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007346
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007347 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7348 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7349 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007350
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007351 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007352 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007353 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007354
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007355 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7356 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7357 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007358
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007359 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007360 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7361 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007362
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007363 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7364
7365 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7366
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007367 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7368
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007369 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007370
7371
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007372tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7373 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007375 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007376 Arguments :
7377 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007378 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007379 "track-sc2" and "capture". See "tcp-request connection" above
7380 for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007381
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007382 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007383
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007384 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7385 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7386 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7387 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7388 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007389
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007390 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7391 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7392 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7393 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007394 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7395 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7396 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7397 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7398 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7399 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007400 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007401 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007402
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007403 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7404 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7405 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7406 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007407
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007408 Four types of actions are supported :
7409 - accept : the request is accepted
7410 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
7411 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007412 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007413
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007414 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7415 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007416
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007417 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7418 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7419 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7420 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7421 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7422 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007423
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007424 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007425 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7426 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007427
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007428 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007429 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7430 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7431 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7432 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007433 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7434 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7435 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007436
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007437 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
7438 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
7439 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
7440 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
7441
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007442 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007443 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7444 # and reject everything else.
7445 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7446 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007447 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007448 tcp-request content reject
7449
7450 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007451 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7452 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7453 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007454 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007455
7456 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7457 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7458 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007459 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007460 tcp-request content reject
7461
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007462 Example:
7463 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7464 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007465 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007466
7467 Example:
7468 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7469 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007470 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007471
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007472 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7473 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7474
7475 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007476 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007477 # protecting all our sites
7478 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007479 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7480 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007481 ...
7482 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7483
7484 backend http_dynamic
7485 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007486 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007487 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007488 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7489 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7490 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007491 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007492
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007493 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007494
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007495 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007496
7497
7498tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7499 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007501 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007502 Arguments :
7503 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7504 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7505 as explained at the top of this document.
7506
7507 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7508 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7509 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7510 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7511 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7512
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007513 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7514 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7515 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7516 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7517
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007518 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7519 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007520 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007521 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007522 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7523 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7524 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7525 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007526
7527 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7528 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7529 it pass through unaffected.
7530
7531 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7532 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7533 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007534 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007535 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7536 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007537 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7538 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7539 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007540
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007541 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007542 "timeout client".
7543
7544
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007545tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7546 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7548 no | no | yes | yes
7549 Arguments :
7550 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007551 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007552
7553 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7554
7555 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7556 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7557 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007558 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7559 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007560
7561 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7562
7563 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7564 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7565 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7566 inserted.
7567
7568 Two types of actions are supported :
7569 - accept :
7570 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7571 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7572 the rules evaluation.
7573
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007574 - close :
7575 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7576 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7577 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7578 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7579 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7580 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007581 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007582 protocols.
7583
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007584 - reject :
7585 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7586 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007587 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007588
7589 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7590 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7591 for changing the default action to a reject.
7592
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007593 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7594 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7595 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7596 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007597 period.
7598
7599 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7600
7601 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7602
7603
7604tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7605 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7607 no | no | yes | yes
7608 Arguments :
7609 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7610 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7611 as explained at the top of this document.
7612
7613 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7614
7615
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007616timeout check <timeout>
7617 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7618 established.
7619
7620 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7621 yes | no | yes | yes
7622 Arguments:
7623 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7624 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7625 as explained at the top of this document.
7626
7627 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7628 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7629 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7630 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007631 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7632 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7633 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007634
7635 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7636 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7637
7638 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7639 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007640 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007641
7642 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7643 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7644 forget about it.
7645
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007646 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7647 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007648
7649
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007650timeout client <timeout>
7651timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7652 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7654 yes | yes | yes | no
7655 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007656 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007657 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7658 as explained at the top of this document.
7659
7660 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7661 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7662 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7663 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7664 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7665 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7666 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7667 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007668 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007669 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007670 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7671 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007672 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
7673 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007674
7675 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7676 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7677 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7678 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7679 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7680 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7681
7682 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7683 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7684 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7685
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007686 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007687
7688
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007689timeout client-fin <timeout>
7690 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
7691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7692 yes | yes | yes | no
7693 Arguments :
7694 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7695 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7696 as explained at the top of this document.
7697
7698 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7699 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7700 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7701 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7702 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
7703 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7704 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7705 down in one direction.
7706
7707 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7708 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7709 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
7710
7711 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
7712
7713
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007714timeout connect <timeout>
7715timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7716 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7718 yes | no | yes | yes
7719 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007720 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007721 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7722 as explained at the top of this document.
7723
7724 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007725 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007726 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007727 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007728 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7729 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007730
7731 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7732 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7733 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7734 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7735 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7736 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7737
7738 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7739 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7740 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7741
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007742 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7743 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007744
7745
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007746timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7747 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7749 yes | yes | yes | yes
7750 Arguments :
7751 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7752 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7753 as explained at the top of this document.
7754
7755 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7756 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7757 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7758 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7759 once the request has started to present itself.
7760
7761 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7762 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7763 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7764 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7765 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7766
7767 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7768 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7769 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7770 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7771
7772 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7773 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7774 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7775 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7776 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007777 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007778
7779 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7780 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7781 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7782 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7783
7784 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7785
7786
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007787timeout http-request <timeout>
7788 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007790 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007791 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007792 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007793 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7794 as explained at the top of this document.
7795
7796 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7797 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7798 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7799 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7800 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7801 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7802 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007803 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
7804 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
7805 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
7806 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
7807 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
7808 code using "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See more details in the explanations of
7809 the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007810
7811 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7812 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007813 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7814 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007815
7816 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7817 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7818 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7819 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7820 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7821
7822 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007823 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7824 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7825 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007826
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007827 See also : "errorfile", "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007828
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007829
7830timeout queue <timeout>
7831 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7833 yes | no | yes | yes
7834 Arguments :
7835 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7836 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7837 as explained at the top of this document.
7838
7839 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7840 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7841 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7842 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7843 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7844
7845 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7846 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7847 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7848 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7849
7850 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7851
7852
7853timeout server <timeout>
7854timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7855 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7857 yes | no | yes | yes
7858 Arguments :
7859 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7860 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7861 as explained at the top of this document.
7862
7863 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7864 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7865 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7866 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7867 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7868 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7869 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7870
7871 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7872 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7873 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7874 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7875 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007876 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007877 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007878 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7879 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7880 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7881 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007882
7883 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7884 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7885 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7886 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7887 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7888 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7889
7890 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7891 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7892 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7893
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007894 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007895
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007896
7897timeout server-fin <timeout>
7898 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
7899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7900 yes | no | yes | yes
7901 Arguments :
7902 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7903 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7904 as explained at the top of this document.
7905
7906 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7907 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7908 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7909 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7910 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
7911 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7912 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7913 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
7914 situations, it should not be needed.
7915
7916 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7917 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7918 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
7919
7920 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
7921
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007922
7923timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007924 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7926 yes | yes | yes | yes
7927 Arguments :
7928 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7929 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7930 as explained at the top of this document.
7931
7932 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7933 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7934 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7935
7936 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7937 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7938 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
7939 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007940 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007941
7942 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7943
7944
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007945timeout tunnel <timeout>
7946 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
7947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7948 yes | no | yes | yes
7949 Arguments :
7950 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7951 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7952 as explained at the top of this document.
7953
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007954 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007955 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
7956 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
7957 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
7958 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
7959 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
7960 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
7961 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
7962 specified.
7963
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007964 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
7965 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
7966 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
7967 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
7968 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
7969 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
7970 state.
7971
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007972 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7973 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7974 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
7975 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
7976 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
7977
7978 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7979 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7980 forget about it.
7981
7982 Example :
7983 defaults http
7984 option http-server-close
7985 timeout connect 5s
7986 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007987 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007988 timeout server 30s
7989 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
7990
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007991 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007992
7993
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007994transparent (deprecated)
7995 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007997 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007998 Arguments : none
7999
8000 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8001 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8002 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8003 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8004 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8005 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8006 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8007 appropriate server.
8008
8009 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8010
8011 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8012 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8013
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008014 See also: "option transparent"
8015
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008016unique-id-format <string>
8017 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8019 yes | yes | yes | no
8020 Arguments :
8021 <string> is a log-format string.
8022
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008023 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8024 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8025 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8026 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008027
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008028 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8029 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8030 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8031 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8032 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8033 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8034 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8035 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008036
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008037 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8038 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008039
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008040 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008041
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008042 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008043
8044 will generate:
8045
8046 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8047
8048 See also: "unique-id-header"
8049
8050unique-id-header <name>
8051 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8053 yes | yes | yes | no
8054 Arguments :
8055 <name> is the name of the header.
8056
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008057 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8058 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008059
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008060 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008061
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008062 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008063 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8064
8065 will generate:
8066
8067 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8068
8069 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008070
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008071use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008072 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8074 no | yes | yes | no
8075 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008076 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8077 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008078
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008079 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8080 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008081
8082 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8083 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8084 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008085 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8086 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8087 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8088 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008089
8090 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8091 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8092 assign the backend.
8093
8094 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8095 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8096 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8097 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8098 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8099 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8100
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008101 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008102 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008103 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8104 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8105 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8106
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008107 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8108 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8109 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8110 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8111 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8112 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8113 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8114 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8115 cannot be forced from the request.
8116
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008117 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008118 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8119 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8120
8121 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8122 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008123
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008124
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008125use-server <server> if <condition>
8126use-server <server> unless <condition>
8127 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8129 no | no | yes | yes
8130 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008131 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008132
8133 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8134
8135 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8136 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8137 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8138
8139 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8140 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8141 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8142 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8143 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8144 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8145 matches will assign the server.
8146
8147 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8148 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8149 with the next rules until one matches.
8150
8151 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8152 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8153 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8154 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8155
8156 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8157 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8158 stripped.
8159
8160 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8161 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8162 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8163 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8164
8165 Example :
8166 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8167 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8168 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8169 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8170 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8171 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8172 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8173 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8174 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8175
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008176 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008177
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008178
81795. Bind and Server options
8180--------------------------
8181
8182The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8183depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8184settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8185written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8186described in this section.
8187
8188
81895.1. Bind options
8190-----------------
8191
8192The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8193as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8194no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8195parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8196while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8197provided immediately after the setting name.
8198
8199The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8200
8201accept-proxy
8202 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02008203 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
8204 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008205 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8206 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8207 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8208 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8209 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8210 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8211 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008212 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8213 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008214
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008215alpn <protocols>
8216 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8217 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8218 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8219 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8220 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8221 initial NPN extension.
8222
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008223backlog <backlog>
8224 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8225 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8226
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008227ecdhe <named curve>
8228 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008229 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8230 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008231
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008232ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008233 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8234 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8235 client's certificate.
8236
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008237ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8238 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8239 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8240 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8241 error is ignored.
8242
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008243ciphers <ciphers>
8244 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8245 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008246 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008247 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8248 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8249
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008250crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008251 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8252 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8253 to verify client's certificate.
8254
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008255crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008256 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8257 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8258 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8259 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8260 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8261 file.
8262
8263 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8264 are loaded.
8265
8266 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
8267 that directory will be loaded. This directive may be specified multiple times
8268 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
8269 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
8270 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
8271 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
8272 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
8273 www.sub.example.org).
8274
8275 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8276 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8277 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8278 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
8279 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
8280
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008281 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008282
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008283 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8284 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008285 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008286 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8287 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8288 clients).
8289
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008290crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008291 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8292 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008293 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008294 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008295
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008296crt-list <file>
8297 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008298 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8299 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008300
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008301 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008302
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008303 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8304 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8305 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8306 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8307 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8308 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8309 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8310 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008311
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008312defer-accept
8313 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8314 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8315 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8316 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8317 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8318 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8319 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8320 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8321 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8322 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8323 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8324
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008325force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008326 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008327 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
8328 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8329
8330force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008331 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008332 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8333
8334force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008335 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008336 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8337
8338force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008339 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008340 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8341
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008342gid <gid>
8343 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8344 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8345 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8346 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8347 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8348
8349group <group>
8350 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8351 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8352 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8353 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8354 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8355
8356id <id>
8357 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8358 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8359 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8360 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8361
8362interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008363 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8364 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8365 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8366 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8367 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8368 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8369 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008370
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008371level <level>
8372 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8373 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8374 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8375 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8376 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8377 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8378 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8379 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8380 counters).
8381 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8382 all counters).
8383
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008384maxconn <maxconn>
8385 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8386 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8387 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8388 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8389 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8390 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8391 eat all memory.
8392
8393mode <mode>
8394 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8395 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8396 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8397 UNIX sockets.
8398
8399mss <maxseg>
8400 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8401 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8402 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8403 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8404 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8405 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8406 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8407 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8408 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8409 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8410 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8411
8412name <name>
8413 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8414 page.
8415
8416nice <nice>
8417 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8418 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8419 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8420 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8421 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8422 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8423 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8424 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8425 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8426 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8427 one for an RDP socket.
8428
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008429no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008430 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008431 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008432 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008433 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8434 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008435
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008436no-tls-tickets
8437 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8438 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8439 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8440 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
8441
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008442no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008443 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008444 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008445 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8446 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8447 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008448
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008449no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008450 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008451 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008452 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8453 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8454 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008455
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008456no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008457 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008458 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008459 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8460 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8461 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008462
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008463npn <protocols>
8464 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8465 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8466 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8467 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008468 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8469 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008470
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008471process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8472 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8473 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
8474 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
8475 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
8476 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
8477 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
8478 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02008479 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
8480 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
8481 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
8482 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
8483 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
8484 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
8485 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008486
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008487ssl
8488 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008489 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008490 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8491 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8492 to deciphered contents.
8493
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008494strict-sni
8495 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8496 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8497 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8498 See the "crt" option for more information.
8499
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008500tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008501 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008502 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8503 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8504 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8505 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8506 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8507 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8508 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008509 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8510 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8511 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008512
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008513transparent
8514 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8515 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8516 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8517 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8518 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8519 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8520 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8521 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8522 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8523 so check for support with your vendor.
8524
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008525v4v6
8526 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8527 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8528 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8529 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008530 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008531
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008532v6only
8533 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8534 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8535 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008536 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8537 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008538
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008539uid <uid>
8540 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8541 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8542 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8543 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8544 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8545
8546user <user>
8547 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8548 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8549 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8550 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8551 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8552
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008553verify [none|optional|required]
8554 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8555 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8556 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8557 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8558 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008559 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8560 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8561 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8562 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008563
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020085645.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008565------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008566
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008567The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8568which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8569arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8570settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8571after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8572Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8573address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008574
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008575 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008576 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008577
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008578The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008579
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008580addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008581 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8582 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8583 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8584 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8585 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008586
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008587 Supported in default-server: No
8588
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008589agent-check
8590 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008591 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
8592 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
8593 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
8594 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008595
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008596 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008597 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
8598 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
8599
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008600 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8601 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008602
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008603 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8604 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
8605 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008606
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008607 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8608 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
8609 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008610
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008611 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
8612 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
8613 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
8614 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
8615 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
8616 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
8617 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008618
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008619 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
8620 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008621
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008622 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
8623 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
8624 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
8625 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
8626 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
8627 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
8628 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
8629 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
8630 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008631
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008632 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8633 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008634 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
8635 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
8636 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
8637 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008638
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008639 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
8640 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008641
8642 Supported in default-server: No
8643
8644agent-inter <delay>
8645 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8646 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8647
8648 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8649 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8650 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8651 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8652 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8653 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8654 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8655 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8656 of backends use the same servers.
8657
8658 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8659
8660 Supported in default-server: Yes
8661
8662agent-port <port>
8663 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8664
8665 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8666
8667 Supported in default-server: Yes
8668
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008669backup
8670 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8671 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8672 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8673 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8674 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8675 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008676
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008677 Supported in default-server: No
8678
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008679ca-file <cafile>
8680 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8681 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8682 server's certificate.
8683
8684 Supported in default-server: No
8685
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008686check
8687 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008688 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8689 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8690 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8691 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8692 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8693 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8694 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008695 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8696 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8697 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008698
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008699 Supported in default-server: No
8700
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008701check-send-proxy
8702 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8703 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8704 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8705 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8706 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8707 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8708 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8709
8710 Supported in default-server: No
8711
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008712check-ssl
8713 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8714 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8715 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8716 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008717 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008718 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8719 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8720 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8721 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8722
8723 Supported in default-server: No
8724
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008725ciphers <ciphers>
8726 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008727 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008728 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8729 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8730 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8731 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8732 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8733 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8734
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008735 Supported in default-server: No
8736
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008737cookie <value>
8738 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8739 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8740 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8741 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8742 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8743 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8744 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8745
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008746 Supported in default-server: No
8747
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008748crl-file <crlfile>
8749 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8750 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8751 to verify server's certificate.
8752
8753 Supported in default-server: No
8754
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008755crt <cert>
8756 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8757 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8758 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8759 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8760 certificate request.
8761
8762 Supported in default-server: No
8763
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008764disabled
8765 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8766 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8767 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8768 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8769 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8770
8771 Supported in default-server: No
8772
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008773error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008774 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8775 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8776 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008777
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008778 Supported in default-server: Yes
8779
8780 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008781
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008782fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008783 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8784 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8785 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8786
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008787 Supported in default-server: Yes
8788
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008789force-sslv3
8790 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8791 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
8792 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8793
8794 Supported in default-server: No
8795
8796force-tlsv10
8797 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8798 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8799
8800 Supported in default-server: No
8801
8802force-tlsv11
8803 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8804 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8805
8806 Supported in default-server: No
8807
8808force-tlsv12
8809 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8810 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8811
8812 Supported in default-server: No
8813
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008814id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008815 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8816 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8817 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008818
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008819 Supported in default-server: No
8820
8821inter <delay>
8822fastinter <delay>
8823downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008824 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8825 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8826 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8827 between checks depending on the server state :
8828
8829 Server state | Interval used
8830 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8831 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8832 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8833 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8834 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8835 or yet unchecked. |
8836 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8837 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8838 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008839
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008840 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8841 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8842 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8843 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008844 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8845 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8846 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8847 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8848 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008849
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008850 Supported in default-server: Yes
8851
8852maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008853 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8854 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8855 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8856 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8857 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8858 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8859 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8860 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8861
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008862 Supported in default-server: Yes
8863
8864maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008865 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
8866 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
8867 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
8868 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
8869 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
8870 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
8871 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
8872
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008873 Supported in default-server: Yes
8874
8875minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008876 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
8877 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
8878 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
8879 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
8880 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
8881 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008882 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008883 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008884
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008885 Supported in default-server: Yes
8886
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008887no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008888 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
8889 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008890 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008891
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008892 Supported in default-server: No
8893
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008894no-tls-tickets
8895 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8896 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8897 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8898 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
8899
8900 Supported in default-server: No
8901
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008902no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008903 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008904 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8905 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008906 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8907 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008908
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008909 Supported in default-server: No
8910
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008911no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008912 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008913 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8914 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008915 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8916 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008917
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008918 Supported in default-server: No
8919
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008920no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008921 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008922 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8923 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008924 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8925 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008926
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008927 Supported in default-server: No
8928
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09008929non-stick
8930 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
8931 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
8932 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
8933
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008934 Supported in default-server: No
8935
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008936observe <mode>
8937 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
8938 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
8939 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
8940 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
8941 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
8942 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01008943 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008944
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008945 Supported in default-server: No
8946
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008947 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
8948
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008949on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008950 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
8951 Currently, four modes are available:
8952 - fastinter: force fastinter
8953 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
8954 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
8955 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
8956 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
8957
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008958 Supported in default-server: Yes
8959
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008960 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
8961
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008962on-marked-down <action>
8963 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
8964 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008965 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
8966 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
8967 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
8968 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
8969 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
8970 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
8971 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
8972 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008973
8974 Actions are disabled by default
8975
8976 Supported in default-server: Yes
8977
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008978on-marked-up <action>
8979 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
8980 Currently one action is available:
8981 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
8982 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
8983 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
8984 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
8985 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
8986 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
8987 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
8988 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
8989
8990 Actions are disabled by default
8991
8992 Supported in default-server: Yes
8993
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008994port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008995 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
8996 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
8997 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
8998 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
8999 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9000 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9001
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009002 Supported in default-server: Yes
9003
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009004redir <prefix>
9005 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9006 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9007 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9008 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9009 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9010 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9011 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9012 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009013 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009014 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9015 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9016 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9017 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9018 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9019
9020 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9021
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009022 Supported in default-server: No
9023
9024rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009025 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9026 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9027 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9028
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009029 Supported in default-server: Yes
9030
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009031send-proxy
9032 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9033 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9034 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9035 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9036 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9037 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9038 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9039 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9040 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009041 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9042 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9043 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9044 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9045 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009046
9047 Supported in default-server: No
9048
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009049send-proxy-v2
9050 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9051 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9052 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9053 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9054 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9055 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9056 option of the "bind" keyword.
9057
9058 Supported in default-server: No
9059
9060send-proxy-v2-ssl
9061 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9062 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9063 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9064 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9065 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9066 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9067 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9068 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9069
9070 Supported in default-server: No
9071
9072send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9073 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9074 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9075 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9076 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9077 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9078 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9079 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9080 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9081 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9082
9083 Supported in default-server: No
9084
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009085slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009086 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9087 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9088 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9089 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9090 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9091 parameters :
9092
9093 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9094 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9095
9096 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9097 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9098 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9099 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9100
9101 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9102 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9103 seen as failed.
9104
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009105 Supported in default-server: Yes
9106
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009107source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009108source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009109source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009110 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9111 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9112 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9113 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9114
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009115 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9116 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9117 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9118 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9119 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9120 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9121 server.
9122
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009123 Supported in default-server: No
9124
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009125ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009126 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9127 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9128 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9129 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9130 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9131 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009132 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009133
9134 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009135
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009136track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009137 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9138 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9139 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9140 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009141 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9142
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009143 Supported in default-server: No
9144
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009145verify [none|required]
9146 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009147 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9148 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9149 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9150 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009151 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9152 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9153 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009154
9155 Supported in default-server: No
9156
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009157verifyhost <hostname>
9158 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9159 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9160 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9161 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9162 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9163 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9164
9165 Supported in default-server: No
9166
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009167weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009168 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9169 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9170 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009171 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9172 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9173 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9174 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9175 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9176 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009177
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009178 Supported in default-server: Yes
9179
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009180
91816. HTTP header manipulation
9182---------------------------
9183
9184In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9185response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9186request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9187which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009188against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009189
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009190If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9191to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9192but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9193HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9194stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9195because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9196a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9197still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009198
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009199This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9200in section 4.2 :
9201
9202 - reqadd <string>
9203 - reqallow <search>
9204 - reqiallow <search>
9205 - reqdel <search>
9206 - reqidel <search>
9207 - reqdeny <search>
9208 - reqideny <search>
9209 - reqpass <search>
9210 - reqipass <search>
9211 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9212 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9213 - reqtarpit <search>
9214 - reqitarpit <search>
9215 - rspadd <string>
9216 - rspdel <search>
9217 - rspidel <search>
9218 - rspdeny <search>
9219 - rspideny <search>
9220 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9221 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9222
9223With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9224is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9225parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9226prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9227Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9228
9229 \t for a tab
9230 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9231 \n for a new line (LF)
9232 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9233 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9234 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9235 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9236 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9237
9238The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9239portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9240above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9241regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
92429 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9243is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9244
9245The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9246after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9247
9248Notes related to these keywords :
9249---------------------------------
9250 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9251 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9252 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9253
9254 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9255 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9256 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9257
9258 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9259 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9260 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9261 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9262 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9263
9264 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9265 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9266 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9267 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9268 useless headers before adding new ones.
9269
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009270 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009271 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9272
9273 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9274 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9275 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9276
9277 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9278 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009279 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009280
9281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020092827. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9283----------------------------------
9284
9285Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9286client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9287The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9288these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9289but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9290data called patterns.
9291
9292
92937.1. ACL basics
9294---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009295
9296The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9297content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9298from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9299simple :
9300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009301 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009302 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009303 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9304 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009306The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9307adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009308
9309In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009311 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009312
9313This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9314Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9315and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009316an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9317conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9318as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9319are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009320
9321ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9322'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9323which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9324
9325There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9326performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009328The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9329specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9330this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009331methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9332ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009333
9334Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9335 - boolean
9336 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9337 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9338 - string
9339 - data block
9340
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009341Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9342converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9343would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9344The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9345which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9346
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009347Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
9348keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
9349fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
9350which are summarized in the table below :
9351
9352 +---------------------+-----------------+
9353 | Sample or converter | Default |
9354 | output type | matching method |
9355 +---------------------+-----------------+
9356 | boolean | bool |
9357 +---------------------+-----------------+
9358 | integer | int |
9359 +---------------------+-----------------+
9360 | ip | ip |
9361 +---------------------+-----------------+
9362 | string | str |
9363 +---------------------+-----------------+
9364 | binary | none, use "-m" |
9365 +---------------------+-----------------+
9366
9367Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
9368matching method, see below.
9369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009370The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9371 - boolean
9372 - integer or integer range
9373 - IP address / network
9374 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9375 - regular expression
9376 - hex block
9377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009378The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9379
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009380 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9381 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009382 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009383 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009384 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009385 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009386 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009388The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9389read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9390if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9391lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9392will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9393beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9394a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9395lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9396exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9397
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009398The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9399parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9400ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9401a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9402check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9403
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009404The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9405socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9406file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009408Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9409loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9410
9411 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9412
9413In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9414the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9415case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9416as well.
9417
9418The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9419sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9420do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9421methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9422is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9423obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9424followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9425default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9426that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9427string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9428
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009429The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9430By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9431string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9432resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9433server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9434waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9435flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9436function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009438There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9439sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9440be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009441
9442 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9443 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009444 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9445 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9446 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9447 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009448
9449 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9450 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009451 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009452
9453 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009454 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009455
9456 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009457 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009458
9459 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9460 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9461
9462 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9463 binary or string samples.
9464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009465 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9466 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009468 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9469 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9470 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009472 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9473 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009475 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9476 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009478 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9479 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009481 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9482 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009483 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009485 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9486 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9487 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009488
9489For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9490request, it is possible to do :
9491
9492 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9493
9494In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9495buffer, one would use the following acl :
9496
9497 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9498
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009499On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9500possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9501
9502 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009504All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9505criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9506method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9507to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9508criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9509the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009511If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009512the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9513For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009515 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9516 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9517 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9518 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009519
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009520
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009521The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
9522types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9523combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
9524brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
9525default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009527 +-------------------------------------------------+
9528 | Input sample type |
9529 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009530 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009531 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9532 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9533 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009534 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009535 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009536 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009537 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009538 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009539 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009540 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009541 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009542 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009543 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009544 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009545 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009546 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009547 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009548 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009549 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009550 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009551 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009552 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009553 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009554 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009555 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9556 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9557 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009558
9559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020095607.1.1. Matching booleans
9561------------------------
9562
9563In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9564Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9565When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9566that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9567
9568Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9569return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9570"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9571
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020095737.1.2. Matching integers
9574------------------------
9575
9576Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9577enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9578to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9579
9580Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9581matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9582lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009583
9584For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9585unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9586representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9587
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009588As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9589two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9590instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9591ranges and operators.
9592
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009593For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009594operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9595Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9596of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009597
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009598Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009599
9600 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9601 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9602 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9603 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9604 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9605
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009606For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009607
9608 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9609
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009610This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9611
9612 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9613
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020096157.1.3. Matching strings
9616-----------------------
9617
9618String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9619different forms :
9620
9621 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9622 patterns ;
9623
9624 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9625 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9626
9627 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9628 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9629
9630 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9631 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9632
9633 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9634 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9635 matches.
9636
9637 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9638 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9639 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009640
9641String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9642exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9643characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9644string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9645to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009646before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009647
9648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020096497.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9650---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009651
9652Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9653they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9654possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9655passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9656the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009657the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9658match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009659
9660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020096617.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9662-------------------------------------
9663
9664It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9665not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9666a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9667to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9668digits may be used upper or lower case.
9669
9670Example :
9671 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9672 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9673
9674
96757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9676---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009677
9678IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9679netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9680within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009681host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009682difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9683at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9684does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9685parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009686
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009687IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9688Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9689trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9690IPv6 patterns.
9691
9692HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9693following situations :
9694 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9695 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9696 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9697 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9698 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9699 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9700 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9701 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9702 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9703 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009705
97067.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9707----------------------------------
9708
9709Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9710combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9711
9712 - AND (implicit)
9713 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9714 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009716A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009718 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009720Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9721indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009723For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9724"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9725requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9726is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9727
9728 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9729 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9730 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9731 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9732
9733To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9734and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9735
9736 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9737 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9738 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9739 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9740
9741 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9742 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9743 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9744 use_backend www if host_www
9745
9746It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9747expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9748be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9749the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9750
9751 The following rule :
9752
9753 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9754 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9755
9756 Can also be written that way :
9757
9758 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9759
9760It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9761to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9762simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9763sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9764good use is the following :
9765
9766 With named ACLs :
9767
9768 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9769 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9770 monitor fail if site_dead
9771
9772 With anonymous ACLs :
9773
9774 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9775
9776See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9777
9778
97797.3. Fetching samples
9780---------------------
9781
9782Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9783against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9784sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9785ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9786of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9787available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9788
9789This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9790Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9791compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9792deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9793
9794The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9795matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9796method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9797indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9798
9799As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9800when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9801mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9802the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9803ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9804
9805Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9806multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9807when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9808incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9809are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9810is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9811all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9812
9813Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9814 - name
9815 - name(arg1)
9816 - name(arg1,arg2)
9817
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009818
98197.3.1. Converters
9820-----------------
9821
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009822Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9823of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9824is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9825was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9826has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9827unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9828
9829These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9830sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9831the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9832support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009834The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009835
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +02009836base64
9837 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
9838 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
9839 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
9840
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009841lower
9842 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
9843 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9844 type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009845
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009846upper
9847 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
9848 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9849 type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009850
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009851hex
9852 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
9853 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
9854 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
9855 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +01009856
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009857ipmask(<mask>)
9858 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
9859 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
9860 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
9861 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009862
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009863http_date([<offset>])
9864 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
9865 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
9866 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
9867 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
9868 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
9869 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009870
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009871language(<value>[,<default>])
9872 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
9873 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
9874 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
9875 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
9876 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
9877 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
9878 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
9879 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
9880 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
9881 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
9882 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
9883 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009884
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009885 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009886
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009887 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
9888 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009889
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009890 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
9891 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
9892 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
9893 use_backend spanish if es
9894 use_backend french if fr
9895 use_backend english if en
9896 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009897
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009898map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9899map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9900map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9901 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
9902 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
9903 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
9904 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
9905 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
9906 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
9907 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
9908 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009909
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009910 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
9911 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
9912 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009913
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009914 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
9915 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009916
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009917 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
9918 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9919 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
9920 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +02009921 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
9922 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009923 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
9924 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9925 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
9926 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9927 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
9928 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9929 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
9930 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9931 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
9932 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9933 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
9934 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9935 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
9936 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009937
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009938 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
9939 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
9940 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
9941 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
9942 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009943
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009944 Example :
9945
9946 # this is a comment and is ignored
9947 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
9948 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
9949 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
9950 | | | `---------- value
9951 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
9952 | `---------------------------- key
9953 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
9954
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009955
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020099567.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009957--------------------------------------------
9958
9959A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
9960not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
9961"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
9962The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
9963
9964always_false : boolean
9965 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9966 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9967
9968always_true : boolean
9969 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9970 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9971
9972avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009973 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009974 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
9975 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
9976 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
9977 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
9978 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
9979 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
9980 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
9981 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
9982 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
9983 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
9984 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
9985 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
9986 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01009987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009988be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009989 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
9990 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
9991 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
9992 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
9993 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009995be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
9996 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9997 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9998 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
9999 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
10000 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
10001 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010002
10003 Example :
10004 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
10005 backend dynamic
10006 mode http
10007 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
10008 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010010connslots([<backend>]) : integer
10011 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010012 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010013 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
10014 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050010015
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010016 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010017 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010018 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
10019
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010020 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
10021 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010022
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010023 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010024 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010025 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010026 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
10027 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010028 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010029 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010030
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010031 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
10032 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010033 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010034 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010035
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010036date([<offset>]) : integer
10037 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
10038 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
10039 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
10040 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020010041 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
10042
10043 Example :
10044
10045 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
10046 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010047
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020010048env(<name>) : string
10049 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
10050 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
10051 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
10052 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
10053 certain way.
10054
10055 Examples :
10056 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
10057 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
10058
10059 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
10060 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
10061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010062fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
10063 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010064 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
10065 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010066 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
10067 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
10068 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
10069 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
10070 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010072fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
10073 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10074 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10075 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
10076 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
10077 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
10078 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
10079 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
10080 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010081
10082 Example :
10083 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
10084 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
10085 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
10086 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
10087 frontend mail
10088 bind :25
10089 mode tcp
10090 maxconn 100
10091 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
10092 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
10093 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
10094 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010096nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
10097 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
10098 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
10099 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010100 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
10101 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
10102 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010104queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010105 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
10106 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
10107 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010108 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
10109 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
10110 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
10111 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
10112 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
10113
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010010114rand([<range>]) : integer
10115 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
10116 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
10117 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
10118 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
10119 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
10120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010121srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10122 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10123 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
10124 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
10125 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
10126 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
10127 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
10128 methods.
10129
10130srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
10131 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
10132 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
10133 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
10134 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
10135 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
10136 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
10137 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
10138
10139srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10140 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10141 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010142 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010143 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
10144 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
10145 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
10146 overloading servers).
10147
10148 Example :
10149 # Redirect to a separate back
10150 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
10151 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
10152 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
10153
10154table_avl([<table>]) : integer
10155 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
10156 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
10157
10158table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10159 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
10160 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
10161 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
10162
10163
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200101647.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010165----------------------------------
10166
10167The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
10168closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
10169methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
10170sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
10171TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010172the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
10173counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
10174"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010175argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
10176the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
10177this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010178
10179be_id : integer
10180 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
10181 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
10182
10183dst : ip
10184 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
10185 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
10186 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
10187 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
10188 RFC 4291.
10189
10190dst_conn : integer
10191 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10192 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
10193 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
10194 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
10195 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
10196 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
10197 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
10198 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010200dst_port : integer
10201 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
10202 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
10203 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
10204 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
10205 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
10206 an HTTP header.
10207
10208fe_id : integer
10209 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
10210 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
10211 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
10212
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010213sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010214sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10215sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10216sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010217 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
10218 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10219 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
10220
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010221sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010222sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10223sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10224sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010225 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
10226 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10227 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
10228
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010229sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010230sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10231sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10232sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010233 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
10234 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010235 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
10236 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
10237 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010238
10239 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10240 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010241 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10242 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
10243 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010244 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10245 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10246
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010247sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010248sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10249sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10250sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010251 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
10252 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
10253
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010254sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010255sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10256sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10257sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010258 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10259 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
10260 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
10261
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010262sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010263sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10264sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10265sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010266 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
10267 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
10268 See also src_conn_rate.
10269
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010270sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010271sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10272sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10273sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010274 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010275 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010276
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010277sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010278sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10279sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10280sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010281 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10282 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
10283 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010284 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10285 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10286 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010287
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010288sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010289sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10290sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10291sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010292 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
10293 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
10294 See also src_http_err_cnt.
10295
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010296sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010297sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10298sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10299sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010300 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
10301 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10302 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
10303 src_http_err_rate.
10304
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010305sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010306sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10307sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10308sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010309 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10310 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10311 src_http_req_cnt.
10312
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010313sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010314sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10315sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10316sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010317 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10318 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
10319 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10320 src_http_req_rate.
10321
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010322sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010323sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10324sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10325sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010326 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010327 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
10328 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
10329 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
10330 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010331
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010332 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10333 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010334 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10335
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010336sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010337sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10338sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10339sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010340 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
10341 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
10342 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10343 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
10344
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010345sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010346sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10347sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10348sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010349 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
10350 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
10351 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10352 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
10353
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010354sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010355sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10356sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10357sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010358 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
10359 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
10360 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
10361 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010362 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010363 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
10364
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010365sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010366sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10367sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10368sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010369 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
10370 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10371 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
10372 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
10373 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010374 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010375
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010376sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010377sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10378sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10379sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020010380 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
10381 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
10382 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
10383
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010384sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010385sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10386sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10387sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010388 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10389 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010390 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010391 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
10392 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010393 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
10394 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
10395 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010397so_id : integer
10398 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
10399 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
10400 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010402src : ip
10403 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
10404 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
10405 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
10406 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
10407 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
10408 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
10409 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010410
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010411 Example:
10412 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
10413 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
10414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010415src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10416 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
10417 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
10418 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010419 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010421src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10422 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
10423 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010424 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010425 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010427src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10428 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10429 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10430 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
10431 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
10432 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
10433 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010434
10435 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10436 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
10437 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
10438 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010439 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010440 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10441 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010443src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010444 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010445 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010446 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010447 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010449src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010450 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010451 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
10452 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010453 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010455src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10456 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
10457 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10458 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010459 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010461src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010462 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010463 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010464 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010465 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010467src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010468 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010469 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010470 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
10471 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010472 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10473 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10474 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010476src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10477 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
10478 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010479 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010480 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010481 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010483src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10484 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
10485 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10486 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10487 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010488 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010490src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10491 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10492 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10493 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010494 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010496src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10497 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10498 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10499 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010500 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010501 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010503src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10504 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10505 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10506 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010507 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010508 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
10509 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010510
10511 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010512 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010513 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010515src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10516 Returns the amount of data received from the incoming connection's source
10517 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10518 measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address
10519 is not found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010520 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also
10521 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010523src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10524 Returns the amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source address
10525 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010526 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
10527 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010528 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010530src_port : integer
10531 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
10532 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
10533 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
10534 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010536src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10537 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010538 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10539 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
10540 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010541 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010543src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10544 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
10545 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10546 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10547 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010548 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010550src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10551 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
10552 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
10553 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
10554 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
10555 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
10556 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
10557 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
10558 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010559
10560 Example :
10561 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
10562 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
10563 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
10564 listen ssh
10565 bind :22
10566 mode tcp
10567 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010568 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010569 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010570 server local 127.0.0.1:22
10571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010572srv_id : integer
10573 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
10574 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
10575 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020010576
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010010577
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200105787.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010579----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020010580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010581The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
10582closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
10583when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
10584usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010585future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010586
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010587ssl_bc : boolean
10588 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10589 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
10590 other a server with the "ssl" option.
10591
10592ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
10593 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
10594 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10595
10596ssl_bc_cipher : string
10597 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
10598 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10599
10600ssl_bc_protocol : string
10601 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
10602 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10603
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010604ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010605 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010606 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10607 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010608
10609ssl_bc_session_id : binary
10610 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
10611 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
10612 if session was reused or not.
10613
10614ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
10615 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
10616 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010618ssl_c_ca_err : integer
10619 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10620 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
10621 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
10622 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
10623 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010625ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
10626 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10627 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
10628 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
10629 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010631ssl_c_err : integer
10632 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10633 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
10634 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
10635 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
10636 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010638ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10639 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10640 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10641 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10642 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10643 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10644 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10645 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10646 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010648ssl_c_key_alg : string
10649 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10650 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10651 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010653ssl_c_notafter : string
10654 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
10655 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10656 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010658ssl_c_notbefore : string
10659 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
10660 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10661 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010663ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10664 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10665 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10666 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10667 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10668 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10669 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10670 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10671 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010673ssl_c_serial : binary
10674 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
10675 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10676 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010678ssl_c_sha1 : binary
10679 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
10680 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
10681 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010683ssl_c_sig_alg : string
10684 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10685 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10686 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010688ssl_c_used : boolean
10689 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
10690 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010692ssl_c_verify : integer
10693 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
10694 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
10695 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
10696 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010698ssl_c_version : integer
10699 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
10700 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010702ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10703 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10704 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10705 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10706 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010707 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010708 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10709 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10710 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010712ssl_f_key_alg : string
10713 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10714 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
10715 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010717ssl_f_notafter : string
10718 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10719 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10720 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010722ssl_f_notbefore : string
10723 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10724 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10725 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010727ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10728 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10729 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10730 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10731 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10732 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10733 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10734 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10735 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010737ssl_f_serial : binary
10738 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10739 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10740 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010741
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020010742ssl_f_sha1 : binary
10743 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
10744 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
10745 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
10746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010747ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10748 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10749 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10750 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010752ssl_f_version : integer
10753 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10754 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10755
10756ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010757 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10758 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10759 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010761 Example :
10762 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10763 listen http-https
10764 bind :80
10765 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10766 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10767
10768ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10769 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10770 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10771
10772ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010773 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010774 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10775 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10776 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10777 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10778 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10779 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10780 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10781 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010783ssl_fc_cipher : string
10784 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10785 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010787ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010788 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10789 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010790 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10791 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10792 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10793 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010795ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10796 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010797 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10798 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10799 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10800 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010802ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010803 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010804 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10805 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10806 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10807 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10808 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10809 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10810 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010812ssl_fc_protocol : string
10813 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10814 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010815
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010816ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010817 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010818 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10819 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010821ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10822 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10823 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
10824 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
10825 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010827ssl_fc_sni : string
10828 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
10829 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
10830 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
10831 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
10832 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
10833
10834 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
10835 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
10836 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020010837 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
10838 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010840 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010841 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
10842 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010844ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
10845 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
10846 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010847
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010848
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200108497.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010850------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010852Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
10853sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
10854only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
10855For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
10856be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
10857can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
10858sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
10859for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
10860content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010862payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
10863 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
10864 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
10865 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010867payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
10868 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
10869 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
10870 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010872req.len : integer
10873req_len : integer (deprecated)
10874 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10875 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10876 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10877 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10878 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10879 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10880 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
10881 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010883req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10884 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010885 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10886 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10887 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10888 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010890 ACL alternatives :
10891 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010893req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10894 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10895 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10896 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
10897 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010899 ACL alternatives :
10900 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010902 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010904req.proto_http : boolean
10905req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
10906 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
10907 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
10908 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
10909 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
10910 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
10911 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
10912 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010914 Example:
10915 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10916 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10917 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010918 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010920req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
10921rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10922 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
10923 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
10924 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
10925 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
10926 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
10927 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
10928 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010930 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
10931 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
10932 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
10933 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
10934 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
10935 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010937 ACL derivatives :
10938 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010940 Example :
10941 listen tse-farm
10942 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
10943 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10944 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10945 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10946 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10947 persist rdp-cookie
10948 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
10949 # This is only useful makes sense if
10950 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
10951 stick-table type string size 204800
10952 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
10953 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10954 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010956 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
10957 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010959req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
10960rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
10961 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
10962 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
10963 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
10964 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010966 ACL derivatives :
10967 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010969req.ssl_hello_type : integer
10970req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10971 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10972 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
10973 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10974 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10975 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
10976 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10977 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010979req.ssl_sni : string
10980req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
10981 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
10982 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
10983 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
10984 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10985 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10986 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
10987 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
10988 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
10989 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
10990 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
10991 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
10992 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010994 ACL derivatives :
10995 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010997 Examples :
10998 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
10999 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11000 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
11001 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
11002 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011004res.ssl_hello_type : integer
11005rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11006 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11007 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
11008 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11009 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11010 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
11011 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11012 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020011013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011014req.ssl_ver : integer
11015req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
11016 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
11017 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
11018 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
11019 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
11020 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11021 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11022 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
11023 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
11024 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011026 ACL derivatives :
11027 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011028
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020011029res.len : integer
11030 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11031 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11032 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11033 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11034 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11035 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11036 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
11037 content inspection.
11038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011039res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11040 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011041 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11042 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11043 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11044 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011046res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11047 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11048 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11049 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
11050 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011052 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011054wait_end : boolean
11055 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
11056 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
11057 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
11058 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
11059 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
11060 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
11061 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
11062 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011064 Examples :
11065 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
11066 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
11067 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011069 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
11070 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11071 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
11072 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
11073 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
11074 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
11075 tcp-request content reject
11076
11077
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200110787.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011079--------------------------------------
11080
11081It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
11082This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
11083data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
11084its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
11085HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
11086content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
11087to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
11088more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
11089response are indexed.
11090
11091base : string
11092 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
11093 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
11094 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
11095 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
11096 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
11097 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
11098 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
11099 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
11100
11101 ACL derivatives :
11102 base : exact string match
11103 base_beg : prefix match
11104 base_dir : subdir match
11105 base_dom : domain match
11106 base_end : suffix match
11107 base_len : length match
11108 base_reg : regex match
11109 base_sub : substring match
11110
11111base32 : integer
11112 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
11113 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
11114 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
11115 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
11116
11117base32+src : binary
11118 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
11119 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
11120 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
11121 per-URL counters.
11122
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011123capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
11124 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
11125 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11126 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
11127
11128capture.req.method : string
11129 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
11130 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
11131 because it's allocated.
11132
11133capture.req.uri : string
11134 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
11135 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
11136 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
11137 allocated.
11138
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011139capture.req.ver : string
11140 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11141 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
11142 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
11143
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011144capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
11145 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
11146 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11147 The first entry is an index of 0.
11148 See also: "capture response header"
11149
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011150capture.res.ver : string
11151 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11152 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
11153 persistent flag.
11154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011155req.cook([<name>]) : string
11156cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11157 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11158 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11159 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
11160 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
11161 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
11162 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
11163 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
11164 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
11165
11166 ACL derivatives :
11167 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
11168 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
11169 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
11170 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
11171 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
11172 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
11173 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
11174 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011176req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11177cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11178 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11179 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011181req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11182cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11183 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11184 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
11185 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
11186 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011188cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11189 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11190 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
11191 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
11192 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
11193 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
11194 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
11195 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
11196 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
11197 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
11198 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011200hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11201 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
11202 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
11203 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
11204 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011205 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011207req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
11208 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11209 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11210 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11211 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11212 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11213 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
11214 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
11215 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011217req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11218 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11219 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11220 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11221 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011223req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11224 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11225 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11226 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11227 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11228 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11229 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
11230 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
11231 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
11232 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
11233 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
11234 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011236 ACL derivatives :
11237 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11238 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11239 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11240 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11241 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11242 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11243 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11244 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11245
11246req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11247hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
11248 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11249 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
11250 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
11251 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
11252 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
11253 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
11254 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
11255 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
11256 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
11257
11258req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11259hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11260 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
11261 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
11262 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
11263 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11264 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11265 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11266 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
11267 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
11268
11269req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11270hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11271 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
11272 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
11273 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
11274 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11275 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11276 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11277 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
11278
11279http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
11280 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
11281 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
11282 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11283 basic auth is supported.
11284
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011285http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
11286 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
11287 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
11288 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
11289 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011290 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11291 basic auth is supported.
11292
11293 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011294 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
11295 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
11296 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
11297 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011298
11299http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011300 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
11301 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011302 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
11303 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011305method : integer + string
11306 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
11307 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
11308 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
11309 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
11310 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
11311 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
11312 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011314 ACL derivatives :
11315 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011317 Example :
11318 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
11319 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
11320 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011322path : string
11323 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
11324 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
11325 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
11326 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
11327 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
11328 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
11329 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011331 ACL derivatives :
11332 path : exact string match
11333 path_beg : prefix match
11334 path_dir : subdir match
11335 path_dom : domain match
11336 path_end : suffix match
11337 path_len : length match
11338 path_reg : regex match
11339 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011341req.ver : string
11342req_ver : string (deprecated)
11343 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
11344 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
11345 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011347 ACL derivatives :
11348 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011350res.comp : boolean
11351 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
11352 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
11353 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011355res.comp_algo : string
11356 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
11357 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
11358 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011360res.cook([<name>]) : string
11361scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11362 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11363 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11364 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011366 ACL derivatives :
11367 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011369res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11370scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11371 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11372 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
11373 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011375res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11376scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11377 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11378 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
11379 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011381res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11382 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11383 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11384 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11385 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11386 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
11387 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
11388 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
11389 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
11390 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011392res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11393 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11394 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11395 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11396 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
11397 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011399res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11400shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
11401 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11402 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11403 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11404 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11405 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
11406 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
11407 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
11408 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011410 ACL derivatives :
11411 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11412 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11413 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11414 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11415 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11416 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11417 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11418 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11419
11420res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11421shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11422 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11423 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11424 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
11425 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
11426 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011428res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11429shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11430 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
11431 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
11432 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
11433 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
11434 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
11435 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011437res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11438shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11439 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
11440 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11441 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11442 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11443 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
11444 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011446res.ver : string
11447resp_ver : string (deprecated)
11448 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
11449 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011451 ACL derivatives :
11452 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011454set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11455 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11456 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
11457 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
11458 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011460 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
11461 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011463 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011465status : integer
11466 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
11467 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
11468 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011470url : string
11471 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
11472 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
11473 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
11474 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
11475 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
11476 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
11477 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011479 ACL derivatives :
11480 url : exact string match
11481 url_beg : prefix match
11482 url_dir : subdir match
11483 url_dom : domain match
11484 url_end : suffix match
11485 url_len : length match
11486 url_reg : regex match
11487 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011489url_ip : ip
11490 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
11491 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
11492 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
11493 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
11494 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
11495 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11496 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011498url_port : integer
11499 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
11500 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
11501 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11502 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011504urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11505url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11506 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
11507 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
11508 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
11509 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
11510 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
11511 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
11512 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
11513 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
11514 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011516 ACL derivatives :
11517 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
11518 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
11519 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
11520 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
11521 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
11522 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
11523 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
11524 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011525
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011527 Example :
11528 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
11529 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
11530 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
11531 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011533urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
11534 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
11535 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
11536 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020011537
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010011538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200115397.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011540---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011541
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011542Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
11543every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011544order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011546ACL name Equivalent to Usage
11547---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011548FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020011549HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011550HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
11551HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011552HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
11553HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
11554HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
11555HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
11556LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011557METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
11558METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
11559METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
11560METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
11561METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
11562METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011563RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011564REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011565TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011566WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
11567---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011568
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011569
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115708. Logging
11571----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011572
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011573One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
11574provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
11575very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
11576provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
11577state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011578to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011579headers.
11580
11581In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
11582about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
11583send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
11584
11585 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
11586 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
11587 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
11588 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
11589 at the termination.
11590
11591The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
11592allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
11593as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
11594while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
11595real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
11596delay.
11597
11598
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115998.1. Log levels
11600---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011601
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011602TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011603source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011604HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
11605in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
11606track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
11607syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
11608about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011609
11610
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116118.2. Log formats
11612----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011613
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011614HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011615and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
11616slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
11617options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011618
11619 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
11620 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
11621 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
11622 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
11623 extents.
11624
11625 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
11626 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
11627 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
11628 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
11629 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
11630
11631 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
11632 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
11633 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
11634 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
11635 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
11636
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020011637 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
11638 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
11639 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
11640 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
11641
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011642 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
11643
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011644Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
11645specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
11646field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
11647servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
11648always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
11649identifier.
11650
11651Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
11652 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
11653 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
11654 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
11655 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
11656
11657
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116588.2.1. Default log format
11659-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011660
11661This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
11662as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
11663format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
11664
11665 Example :
11666 listen www
11667 mode http
11668 log global
11669 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11670
11671 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
11672 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
11673 (www/HTTP)
11674
11675 Field Format Extract from the example above
11676 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
11677 2 'Connect from' Connect from
11678 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
11679 4 'to' to
11680 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
11681 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
11682
11683Detailed fields description :
11684 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
11685 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
11686 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
11687 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
11688 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11689 and processed the connection.
11690 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
11691
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011692In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
11693"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
11694connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
11695
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011696It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
11697will eventually disappear.
11698
11699
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117008.2.2. TCP log format
11701---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011702
11703The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
11704is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
11705information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
11706counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
11707emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
11708environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
11709the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
11710sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011711specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
11712not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
11713fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
11714marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011715
11716 Example :
11717 frontend fnt
11718 mode tcp
11719 option tcplog
11720 log global
11721 default_backend bck
11722
11723 backend bck
11724 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11725
11726 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
11727 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
11728 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
11729
11730 Field Format Extract from the example above
11731 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
11732 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
11733 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
11734 4 frontend_name fnt
11735 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
11736 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
11737 7 bytes_read* 212
11738 8 termination_state --
11739 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
11740 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11741
11742Detailed fields description :
11743 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011744 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11745 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11746 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11747 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11748 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011749
11750 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011751 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11752 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11753 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011754
11755 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
11756 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
11757 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
11758 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
11759
11760 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11761 and processed the connection.
11762
11763 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11764 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11765 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
11766 applications.
11767
11768 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11769 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11770 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11771 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11772 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11773
11774 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11775 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11776 See "Timers" below for more details.
11777
11778 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11779 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11780 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11781 "Timers" below for more details.
11782
11783 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011784 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011785 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11786 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11787 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11788 details.
11789
11790 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11791 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11792 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11793 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11794 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11795
11796 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11797 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11798 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11799 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11800 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11801 for more details.
11802
11803 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011804 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011805 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11806 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11807 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011808 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011809
11810 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11811 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11812 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11813 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11814 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11815 caused by a denial of service attack.
11816
11817 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11818 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11819 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11820 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11821 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11822 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11823 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11824 denial of service attack.
11825
11826 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11827 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11828 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11829 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11830 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11831 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11832 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11833 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
11834 be processed than on other servers.
11835
11836 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11837 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11838 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11839 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11840 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11841 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11842 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11843 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11844 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11845 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11846 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11847 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11848 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11849
11850 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11851 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11852 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11853 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11854 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11855 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11856 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11857 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11858
11859 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11860 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11861 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11862 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11863 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11864 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11865 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11866 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11867 occurs.
11868
11869
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118708.2.3. HTTP log format
11871----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011872
11873The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
11874is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
11875the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
11876are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
11877emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
11878generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
11879"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
11880which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011881frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
11882is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011883
11884Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
11885slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
11886with a star ('*') after the field name below.
11887
11888 Example :
11889 frontend http-in
11890 mode http
11891 option httplog
11892 log global
11893 default_backend bck
11894
11895 backend static
11896 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11897
11898 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
11899 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
11900 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011901 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011902
11903 Field Format Extract from the example above
11904 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
11905 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
11906 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
11907 4 frontend_name http-in
11908 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
11909 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
11910 7 status_code 200
11911 8 bytes_read* 2750
11912 9 captured_request_cookie -
11913 10 captured_response_cookie -
11914 11 termination_state ----
11915 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
11916 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11917 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
11918 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
11919 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011920
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011921
11922Detailed fields description :
11923 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011924 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11925 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11926 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11927 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11928 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011929
11930 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011931 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11932 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11933 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011934
11935 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
11936 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
11937 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
11938 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
11939 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
11940
11941 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11942 and processed the connection.
11943
11944 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11945 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11946 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
11947
11948 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11949 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11950 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11951 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
11952 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
11953 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
11954
11955 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
11956 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
11957 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
11958 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
11959 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
11960 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
11961
11962 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11963 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11964 See "Timers" below for more details.
11965
11966 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11967 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11968 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
11969 below for more details.
11970
11971 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
11972 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
11973 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
11974 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
11975 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
11976 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
11977 for more details.
11978
11979 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011980 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011981 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11982 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11983 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11984 details.
11985
11986 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
11987 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
11988 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
11989
11990 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
11991 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
11992 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
11993 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
11994 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
11995 overflowing.
11996
11997 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
11998 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
11999 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
12000 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
12001 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
12002 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
12003 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
12004 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12005
12006 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
12007 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
12008 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
12009 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
12010 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
12011 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
12012 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
12013 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12014
12015 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12016 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12017 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
12018 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
12019 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
12020 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
12021 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
12022
12023 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012024 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012025 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
12026 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
12027 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012028 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012029 system.
12030
12031 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12032 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12033 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12034 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12035 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12036 caused by a denial of service attack.
12037
12038 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12039 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12040 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12041 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12042 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12043 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12044 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12045 denial of service attack.
12046
12047 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12048 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12049 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12050 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12051 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12052 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12053 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12054 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
12055 processed than on other servers.
12056
12057 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12058 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12059 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12060 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12061 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12062 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12063 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12064 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12065 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12066 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12067 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12068 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12069 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12070
12071 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12072 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12073 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12074 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12075 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12076 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12077 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12078 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12079
12080 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12081 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12082 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12083 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12084 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12085 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12086 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12087 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12088 occurs.
12089
12090 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
12091 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
12092 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
12093 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
12094 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
12095 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
12096 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
12097 cookies" below for more details.
12098
12099 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
12100 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
12101 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
12102 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
12103 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
12104 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
12105 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
12106 and cookies" below for more details.
12107
12108 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
12109 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
12110 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
12111 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
12112 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
12113 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
12114 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
12115 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
12116
12117
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200121188.2.4. Custom log format
12119------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012120
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012121The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012122mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012123
12124HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
12125Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
12126separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
12127prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
12128
12129Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
12130variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
12131string formats ("Q").
12132
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012133If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012134as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012135less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
12136the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
12137
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012138Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012139In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010012140in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012141
12142Flags are :
12143 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012144 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012145
12146 Example:
12147
12148 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
12149 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
12150
12151At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
12152
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012153 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
12154 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012155
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012156the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012157
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012158 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012159 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012160 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012161
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012162and the default TCP format is defined this way :
12163
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012164 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012165 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
12166
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012167Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
12168
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012169 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012170 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012171 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
12172 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
12173 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012174 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
12175 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
12176 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012177 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012178 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020012179 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012180 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012181 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080012182 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012183 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
12184 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012185 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012186 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
12187 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012188 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012189 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
12190 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012191 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12192 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
12193 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012194 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012195 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
12196 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012197 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012198 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12199 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
12200 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012201 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012202 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
12203 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
12204 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
12205 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012206 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012207 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012208 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012209 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010012210 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012211 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012212 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
12213 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
12214 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012215 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012216 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
12217 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012218 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012219 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012220 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012221 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012222
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012223 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012224
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010012225
122268.2.5. Error log format
12227-----------------------
12228
12229When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
12230protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
12231By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
12232"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
12233will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
12234logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
12235
12236The format looks like this :
12237
12238 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
12239 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
12240 Connection error during SSL handshake
12241
12242 Field Format Extract from the example above
12243 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
12244 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
12245 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
12246 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
12247 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
12248
12249These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
12250failures.
12251
12252
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122538.3. Advanced logging options
12254-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012255
12256Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
12257just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
12258options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
12259for more information about their usage.
12260
12261
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122628.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
12263------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012264
12265It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
12266haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
12267commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
12268monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
12269ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
12270
12271 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
12272 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
12273 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
12274 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
12275
12276 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
12277 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
12278 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012279 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012280 such as other load-balancers.
12281
12282 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
12283 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
12284 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
12285
12286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122878.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
12288----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012289
12290The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
12291what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
12292or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
12293"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
12294just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
12295log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
12296after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
12297is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
12298with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
12299with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
12300
12301
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123028.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
12303------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012304
12305Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
12306for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
12307"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
12308retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
12309raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
12310a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
12311file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
12312you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
12313"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
12314
12315
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123168.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
12317--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012318
12319Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
12320multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
12321them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
12322"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
12323logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
12324error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
12325and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
12326too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
12327useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
12328alternative.
12329
12330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123318.4. Timing events
12332------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012333
12334Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
12335reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
12336the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
12337frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
12338mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
12339
12340 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
12341 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
12342 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
12343 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
12344 the client closes prematurely or times out.
12345
12346 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
12347 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
12348 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
12349 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
12350 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
12351
12352 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
12353 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
12354 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
12355 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
12356 connection never established.
12357
12358 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
12359 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
12360 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
12361 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
12362 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
12363 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
12364 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
12365 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
12366 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
12367 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
12368 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
12369
12370 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
12371 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
12372 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
12373 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012374 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012375
12376 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
12377
12378 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
12379 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
12380 negative.
12381
12382These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
12383protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
12384that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012385due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012386close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
12387session has been aborted on timeout.
12388
12389Most common cases :
12390
12391 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12392 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
12393 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
12394 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
12395 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
12396 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
12397 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
12398 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
12399 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020012400 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
12401 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
12402 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012403
12404 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12405 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
12406 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
12407 of ms on remote networks.
12408
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012409 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
12410 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
12411 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012412
12413 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
12414 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
12415 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
12416 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
12417 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
12418 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
12419 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
12420 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
12421 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
12422 to the server until another one is released.
12423
12424Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
12425
12426 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
12427 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
12428 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
12429
12430 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
12431 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
12432 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
12433
12434 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
12435 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
12436 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
12437 flags.
12438
12439 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
12440 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
12441 Check the session termination flags, then check the
12442 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
12443 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
12444 the client connection was maintained open.
12445
12446 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012447 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012448 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
12449 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
12450
12451
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124528.5. Session state at disconnection
12453-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012454
12455TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
12456"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
124572-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
12458each of which has a special meaning :
12459
12460 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
12461 session to terminate :
12462
12463 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
12464
12465 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
12466 server explicitly refused it.
12467
12468 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
12469 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
12470 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
12471 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012472 (eg: cacheable cookie).
12473
12474 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
12475 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012476
12477 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
12478 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
12479 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
12480 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
12481 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
12482
12483 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
12484 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
12485 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
12486 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
12487 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
12488
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090012489 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
12490 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
12491
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012492 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
12493 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
12494 backup connections when going up.
12495
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020012496 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
12497
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012498 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
12499 send or receive data.
12500
12501 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
12502 send or receive data.
12503
12504 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
12505 with nothing left in the buffers.
12506
12507 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
12508
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010012509 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012510 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
12511
12512 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
12513 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
12514 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
12515 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
12516 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
12517
12518 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
12519 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
12520
12521 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
12522 server (HTTP only).
12523
12524 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
12525
12526 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
12527 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
12528 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
12529
12530 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
12531 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
12532 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
12533
12534 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
12535
12536 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
12537 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
12538
12539 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
12540 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
12541 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
12542
12543 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
12544 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020012545 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
12546 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012547
12548 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
12549 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
12550 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
12551 another server.
12552
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012553 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012554 server.
12555
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012556 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
12557 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
12558 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
12559 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12560
12561 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
12562 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
12563 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
12564 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12565
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020012566 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
12567 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
12568 "use-server" rule).
12569
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012570 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12571
12572 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
12573 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
12574
12575 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
12576
12577 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
12578 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
12579 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
12580
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012581 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
12582 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012583 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012584 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
12585 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
12586
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012587 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
12588
12589 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
12590 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
12591
12592 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
12593
12594 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12595
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012596The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
12597was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012598helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
12599starvation, attacks, etc...
12600
12601The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
12602alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
12603easier finding and understanding.
12604
12605 Flags Reason
12606
12607 -- Normal termination.
12608
12609 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
12610 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
12611 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
12612 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
12613
12614 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
12615 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
12616 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
12617 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
12618 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
12619 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012620
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012621 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12622 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012623 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012624
12625 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
12626 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
12627 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
12628
12629 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
12630 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
12631 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
12632 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
12633 the server takes too long to respond.
12634
12635 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
12636 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
12637 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
12638 long a time to respond.
12639
12640 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
12641 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
12642 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
12643 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
12644 and the client.
12645
12646 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
12647 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
12648 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
12649 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
12650 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012651 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
12652 some browsers such as Google Chrome started to break the deployed Web
12653 infrastructure by aggressively implementing a new "pre-connect"
12654 feature, consisting in sending connections to sites recently visited
12655 without sending any request on them until the user starts to browse
12656 the site. This mechanism causes massive disruption among resource-
12657 limited servers, and causes a lot of 408 errors in HAProxy logs.
12658 Worse, some people report that sometimes the browser displays the 408
12659 error when the user expects to see the actual content (Mozilla fixed
12660 this bug in 2004, while Chrome users continue to report it in 2014),
12661 so in this case, using "errorfile 408 /dev/null" can be used as a
12662 workaround. More information on the subject is available here :
12663 https://bugzilla.mozilla.org/show_bug.cgi?id=248827
12664 https://code.google.com/p/chromium/issues/detail?id=85229
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012665
12666 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
12667 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012668 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
12669 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
12670 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
12671 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012672
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012673 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
12674 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
12675
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012676 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012677 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
12678 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
12679 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
12680 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
12681 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
12682
12683 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
12684 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
12685 503 or 504 here.
12686
12687 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
12688 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
12689 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
12690 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
12691 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
12692
12693 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12694 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012695 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012696 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
12697 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
12698
12699 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
12700 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
12701 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
12702 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
12703 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
12704 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
12705 between haproxy and the server.
12706
12707 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
12708 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
12709 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
12710 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
12711 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
12712 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
12713 solution is to fix the application.
12714
12715 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
12716 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
12717 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
12718 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
12719 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
12720 external attacks.
12721
12722 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
12723 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012724 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012725 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
12726 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
12727
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012728 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
12729 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
12730 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020012731 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
12732 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012733
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012734 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
12735 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
12736 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
12737 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012738 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
12739 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
12740 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
12741 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
12742 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012743
12744 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
12745 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
12746 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
12747 returned an HTTP 403 error.
12748
12749 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
12750 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
12751 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
12752 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
12753
12754 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
12755 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
12756 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
12757 only be solved by proper system tuning.
12758
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012759The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
12760persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
12761important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
12762re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
12763
12764 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
12765
12766 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12767 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
12768 set on a GET request.
12769
12770 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
12771 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012772 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012773 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
12774
12775 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
12776 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
12777 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
12778
12779 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12780 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
12781 already got a cookie.
12782
12783 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12784 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12785 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12786 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12787 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12788
12789 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12790 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12791 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12792
12793 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12794 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12795 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12796
12797 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12798 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12799
12800 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12801 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12802 then advertised in the response.
12803
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012804
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128058.6. Non-printable characters
12806-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012807
12808In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12809consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
12810converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
12811prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
12812being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
12813escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12814is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12815'}' when logging headers.
12816
12817Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12818issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12819containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12820
12821Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12822the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12823performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
12824
12825
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128268.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
12827---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012828
12829Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
12830achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012831section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012832cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
12833the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
12834the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012835locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012836not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
12837user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
12838a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
12839wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
12840
12841 Examples :
12842 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
12843 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
12844
12845 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
12846 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
12847
12848
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128498.8. Capturing HTTP headers
12850---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012851
12852Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
12853proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
12854the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
12855server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
12856
12857Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
12858response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012859section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012860
12861It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012862time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
12863appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012864are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
12865and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
12866follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
12867request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
12868in the logs.
12869
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012870As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
12871frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
12872an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
12873
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012874 Example :
12875 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
12876 listen proxy-out
12877 mode http
12878 option httplog
12879 option logasap
12880 log global
12881 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
12882
12883 # log the name of the virtual server
12884 capture request header Host len 20
12885
12886 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
12887 capture request header Content-Length len 10
12888
12889 # log the beginning of the referrer
12890 capture request header Referer len 20
12891
12892 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
12893 capture response header Server len 20
12894
12895 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
12896 capture response header Content-Length len 10
12897
12898 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
12899 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
12900
12901 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
12902 capture response header Via len 20
12903
12904 # log the URL location during a redirection
12905 capture response header Location len 20
12906
12907 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
12908 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
12909 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12910 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
12911 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
12912
12913 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12914 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12915 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12916 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012917 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012918
12919 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12920 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12921 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12922 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
12923 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012924 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012925
12926
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129278.9. Examples of logs
12928---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012929
12930These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
12931them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
12932reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
12933
12934 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
12935 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12936 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12937
12938 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
12939 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
12940
12941 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
12942 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
12943 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12944
12945 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
12946 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
12947
12948 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
12949 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12950 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
12951
12952 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012953 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012954 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
12955 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
12956
12957 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
12958 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
12959 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
12960
12961 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
12962 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020012963 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012964 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
12965 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
12966 to return the 502 and not the server.
12967
12968 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012969 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012970
12971 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
12972 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
12973 Nothing was sent to any server.
12974
12975 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
12976 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
12977
12978 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
12979 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
12980 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
12981 send a 408 return code to the client.
12982
12983 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
12984 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
12985
12986 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
12987 5 seconds ("c----").
12988
12989 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
12990 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012991 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012992
12993 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012994 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012995 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
12996 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
12997 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
12998 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
12999 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013000
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013001
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130029. Statistics and monitoring
13003----------------------------
13004
13005It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
13006mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
13007CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
13008Unix socket.
13009
13010
130119.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013012---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013013
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013014The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020013015page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
13016begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
13017represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
13018use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
13019('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
13020(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
13021text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
13022do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
13023use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013024
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013025 0. pxname: proxy name
13026 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
13027 for server)
13028 2. qcur: current queued requests
13029 3. qmax: max queued requests
13030 4. scur: current sessions
13031 5. smax: max sessions
13032 6. slim: sessions limit
13033 7. stot: total sessions
13034 8. bin: bytes in
13035 9. bout: bytes out
13036 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013037 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013038 12. ereq: request errors
13039 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010013040 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013041 15. wretr: retries (warning)
13042 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010013043 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013044 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
13045 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
13046 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
13047 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
13048 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
13049 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
13050 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
13051 25. qlimit: queue limit
13052 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
13053 27. iid: unique proxy id
13054 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
13055 29. throttle: warm up status
13056 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
13057 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020013058 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020013059 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
13060 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
13061 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020013062 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013063 UNK -> unknown
13064 INI -> initializing
13065 SOCKERR -> socket error
13066 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
13067 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
13068 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
13069 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
13070 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
13071 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
13072 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
13073 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
13074 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
13075 disable-on-404
13076 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
13077 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
13078 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020013079 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
13080 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013081 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
13082 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
13083 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
13084 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
13085 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
13086 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013087 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
13088 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
13089 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
13090 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010013091 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
13092 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010013093 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
13094 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
13095 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010013096 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreauf522f3d2014-02-10 22:22:49 +010013097 55. lastsess: number of seconds since last session assigned to server/backend
Willy Tarreaua28df3e2014-06-16 16:40:14 +020013098 56. last_chk: last health check contents or textual error
13099 57. last_agt: last agent check contents or textual error
Willy Tarreauf5b1cc32014-06-17 12:20:59 +020013100 58. qtime: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13101 59. ctime: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13102 60. rtime: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests (0 for TCP)
13103 61. ttime: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013104
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013105
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131069.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013107-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013108
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013109The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
13110necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
13111A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
13112issuing commands by hand :
13113
13114 global
13115 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13116 stats timeout 2m
13117
13118It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
13119the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
13120never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
13121situations :
13122
13123 global
13124 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13125 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
13126 stats timeout 2m
13127
13128To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
13129swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
13130to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
13131syntaxes we'll use are the following :
13132
13133 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
13134 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
13135
13136The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
13137script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
13138for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
13139
13140The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
13141that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
13142editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
13143(eg: watch a counter).
13144
13145The socket supports two operation modes :
13146 - interactive
13147 - non-interactive
13148
13149The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
13150this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
13151sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
13152mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
13153commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
13154example :
13155
13156 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
13157
13158The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
13159entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
13160for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
13161sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
13162"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
13163after processing the last command of the same line.
13164
13165For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
13166"prompt" command :
13167
13168 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
13169 prompt
13170 > show info
13171 ...
13172 >
13173
13174Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
13175delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
13176that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
13177parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013178
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013179It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
13180on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
13181own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013182
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013183The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
13184If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
13185all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
13186it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
13187
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013188add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013189 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
13190 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
13191 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
13192 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013193
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013194add map <map> <key> <value>
13195 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
13196 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013197 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
13198 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
13199 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013200
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013201clear counters
13202 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
13203 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
13204 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
13205 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
13206 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13207
13208clear counters all
13209 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
13210 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
13211 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
13212
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013213clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013214 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
13215 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
13216 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013217
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013218clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013219 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
13220 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
13221 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013222
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013223clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
13224 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
13225
13226 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
13227 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
13228 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
13229 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
13230 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
13231 later after the session ends is usual enough.
13232
13233 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
13234
13235 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
13236 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
13237 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
13238 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
13239 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
13240 the ACLs :
13241
13242 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13243 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13244 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13245 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13246 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13247 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13248
13249 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013250 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
13251 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013252
13253 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013254 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013255 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013256 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13257 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13258 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13259 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013260
13261 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13262
13263 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013264 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013265 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13266 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013267 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13268 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13269 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013270
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013271del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
13272 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013273 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
13274 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13275 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
13276 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013277
13278del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013279 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013280 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
13281 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13282 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
13283 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013284
13285disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013286 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
13287
13288 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
13289 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
13290 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
13291 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
13292 re-enabled using enable agent.
13293
13294 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
13295 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
13296 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
13297 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
13298 otherwise unchanged.
13299
13300 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
13301 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
13302 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
13303
13304 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13305 level "admin".
13306
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013307disable frontend <frontend>
13308 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
13309 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
13310 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
13311 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
13312 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
13313 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
13314 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
13315 on the stats page.
13316
13317 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13318 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13319
13320 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13321 level "admin".
13322
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013323disable health <backend>/<server>
13324 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
13325 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
13326 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
13327 agent check forces it down.
13328
13329 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13330 level "admin".
13331
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013332disable server <backend>/<server>
13333 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
13334 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
13335 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
13336 during the maintenance.
13337
13338 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
13339 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
13340
13341 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013342 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013343
13344 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13345 level "admin".
13346
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013347enable agent <backend>/<server>
13348 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
13349
13350 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
13351 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
13352
13353 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13354 level "admin".
13355
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013356enable frontend <frontend>
13357 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
13358 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
13359 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
13360 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
13361 which was disabled.
13362
13363 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13364 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13365
13366 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13367 level "admin".
13368
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013369enable health <backend>/<server>
13370 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
13371 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
13372
13373 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13374 level "admin".
13375
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013376enable server <backend>/<server>
13377 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
13378 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
13379
13380 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013381 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013382
13383 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13384 level "admin".
13385
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013386get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013387get acl <acl> <value>
13388 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
13389 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
13390 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
13391 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
13392 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013393
13394 The first two words are:
13395
13396 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
13397 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
13398 "dom", "end" or "reg".
13399
13400 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
13401
13402 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
13403
13404 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
13405
13406 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
13407 interpretation of the case.
13408
13409 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
13410 useful with regular expressions.
13411
13412 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
13413 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
13414
13415 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
13416 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
13417 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
13418
13419 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
13420
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013421get weight <backend>/<server>
13422 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
13423 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
13424 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
13425 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
13426 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013427 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013428
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013429help
13430 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
13431 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013432
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013433prompt
13434 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
13435 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
13436 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
13437 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
13438 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
13439 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
13440 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
13441 command.
13442
13443quit
13444 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013445
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013446set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013447 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
13448 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
13449 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013450
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013451set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020013452 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
13453 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
13454 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
13455 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
13456 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013457 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
13458 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13459
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020013460set maxconn global <maxconn>
13461 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
13462 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
13463 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
13464 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
13465 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
13466 setting.
13467
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020013468set rate-limit connections global <value>
13469 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
13470 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13471 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13472 is passed in number of connections per second.
13473
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013474set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
13475 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
13476 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010013477 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
13478 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013479
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020013480set rate-limit sessions global <value>
13481 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
13482 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13483 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13484 is passed in number of sessions per second.
13485
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020013486set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
13487 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
13488 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13489 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13490 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
13491 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
13492
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020013493set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
13494 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13495 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
13496 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13497
13498set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
13499 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13500 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
13501 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13502
13503set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
13504 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
13505 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
13506 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
13507 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
13508 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
13509 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
13510 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
13511 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
13512
13513set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
13514 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
13515 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
13516
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013517set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013518 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
13519 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
13520 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
13521 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013522 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
13523 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013524
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013525set timeout cli <delay>
13526 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
13527 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
13528 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
13529
13530set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
13531 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
13532 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090013533 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
13534 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
13535 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
13536 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
13537 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
13538 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
13539 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
13540 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
13541 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
13542 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
13543 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
13544 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
13545 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013546
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013547show errors [<iid>]
13548 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
13549 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013550 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
13551 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
13552 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013553
13554 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
13555 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
13556 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
13557 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
13558 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
13559 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
13560 are reported too.
13561
13562 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
13563 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
13564 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
13565 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
13566 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
13567 code.
13568
13569 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
13570 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
13571 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
13572 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
13573 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
13574 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
13575 line.
13576
13577 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013578 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13579 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013580 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
13581 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
13582
13583 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
13584 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
13585 00038 Location: blah\r\n
13586 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
13587 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
13588 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
13589 00204+ minal\r\n
13590 00211 \r\n
13591
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013592 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013593 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
13594 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
13595 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
13596 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
13597 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
13598 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013599
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013600show info
13601 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
13602
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013603show map [<map>]
13604 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013605 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
13606 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
13607 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
13608 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
13609 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
13610 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013611
13612show acl [<acl>]
13613 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013614 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
13615 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
13616 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
13617 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
13618 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013619
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010013620show pools
13621 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
13622 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
13623 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
13624 the pools.
13625
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013626show sess
13627 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013628 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
13629 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13630
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010013631show sess <id>
13632 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
13633 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13634 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
13635 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
13636 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010013637 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
13638 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
13639 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013640
13641show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
13642 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
13643 possible to dump only selected items :
13644 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
13645 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
13646 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
13647 for example:
13648 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
13649 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
13650 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
13651
13652 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013653 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
13654 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013655 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
13656 Release_date: 2009/09/23
13657 Nbproc: 1
13658 Process_num: 1
13659 (...)
13660
13661 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
13662 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
13663 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
13664 (...)
13665 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
13666
13667 $
13668
13669 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
13670 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
13671 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
13672 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013673 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013674
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013675show table
13676 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
13677 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
13678 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
13679 entries currently in use.
13680
13681 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013682 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013683 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
13684 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013685
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013686show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013687 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
13688 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
13689 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013690 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
13691
13692 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
13693 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
13694 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
13695 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
13696 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
13697
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013698 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13699 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13700 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13701 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13702 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13703 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13704
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013705
13706 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013707 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
13708 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013709
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013710 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013711 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013712 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013713 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13714 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13715 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13716 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013717
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013718 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013719 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013720 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13721 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013722
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013723 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
13724 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013725 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013726 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13727 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013728
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013729 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
13730 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013731 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013732 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13733 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
13734
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013735 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
13736 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
13737 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
13738 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
13739 time goes, the average event rate drops.
13740
13741 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
13742 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
13743 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013744 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
13745 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013746 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
13747 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020013748
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013749shutdown frontend <frontend>
13750 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
13751 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
13752 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
13753 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
13754 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
13755 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
13756 once it is terminated.
13757
13758 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13759 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13760
13761 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13762 level "admin".
13763
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020013764shutdown session <id>
13765 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
13766 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13767 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
13768 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
13769 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
13770 flag in the logs.
13771
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020013772shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
13773 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
13774 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
13775 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
13776 'K' flag in the logs.
13777
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013778/*
13779 * Local variables:
13780 * fill-column: 79
13781 * End:
13782 */